blob: 1c39f050f5013603b60ecc3d653300433035c3a8 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswell482202a2003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner216c7b82003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattnerbfb1d032003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattnerb4cfa7f2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner024f4ab2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000043#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
44#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000046#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000047#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +000048#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000049#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +000050#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000051#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattner3d27be12006-08-27 12:54:02 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000053#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer7c16caa2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +000058#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +000059#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000060using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +000061using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +000062
Chris Lattner79a42ac2006-12-19 21:40:18 +000063STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
64STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
65STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnerbf3a0992002-10-01 22:38:41 +000068
Chris Lattner79a42ac2006-12-19 21:40:18 +000069namespace {
Chris Lattner4a4c7fe2006-06-28 22:08:15 +000070 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
71 : public FunctionPass,
72 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +000073 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000074 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
75 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +000076 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +000077 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 public:
79 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
80 /// isn't already in it.
81 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
82 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
83 Worklist.push_back(I);
84 }
85
86 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
87 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
88 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
89 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
90
91 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
92 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
93
94 WorklistMap.erase(It);
95 }
96
97 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
98 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
99 Worklist.pop_back();
100 WorklistMap.erase(I);
101 return I;
102 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000103
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000104
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000105 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
106 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
107 /// now.
108 ///
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000109 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000110 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000111 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000112 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000113 }
114
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000115 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
116 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
117 ///
118 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
119 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
120 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000121 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000122 }
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000123
124 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
125 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
126 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
127 ///
128 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
129 ///
130 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
131 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
132
133 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
134 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000135 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000136 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
137 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
138 }
139
140 return R;
141 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000142
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000143 public:
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000144 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000145
146 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000147
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000148 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000149 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersona6968f82006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000150 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattner820d9712002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000151 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattnerf12cc842002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000152 }
153
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000154 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
155
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000156 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
157 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
158 // Return Value:
159 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000160 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000161 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000162 //
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000163 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
164 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
165 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000166 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
167 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
169 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000171 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
175 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000176 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000179 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000183 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
184 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
185 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000186
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000187 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
188 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000189 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000190 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000191 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
192 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
193 Instruction *visitTrunc(CastInst &CI);
194 Instruction *visitZExt(CastInst &CI);
195 Instruction *visitSExt(CastInst &CI);
196 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
197 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
198 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
199 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
200 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
201 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
202 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
203 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitBitCast(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000205 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
206 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000207 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000208 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000210 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
211 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000212 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000213 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000214 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000215 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000216 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000217 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000218 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000219 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000220 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000221
222 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000223 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000224
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000225 private:
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000226 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000227 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
228
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000229 public:
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000230 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
231 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
232 //
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000233 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattner65217ff2002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000234 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
235 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000236 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
237 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000238 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000239 return New;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000240 }
241
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000242 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
243 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
244 /// cast.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000245 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
246 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000247 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000248
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000249 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000250 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000251
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000252 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000253 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000254 return C;
255 }
256
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000257 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
258 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
259 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
260 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
261 // modified.
262 //
263 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000264 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000265 if (&I != V) {
266 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
267 return &I;
268 } else {
269 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
270 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000271 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000272 return &I;
273 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000274 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000275
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000276 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
277 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
278 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
279 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
280 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
281 //
282 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
283 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
284 if (Old != New)
285 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
286 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000287 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000288 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000289 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2590e512006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000290 return true;
291 }
292
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000293 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
294 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
295 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
296 // this function.
297 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
298 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
299 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000300 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner95307542004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000301 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000302 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
303 }
304
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000305 private:
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000306 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
307 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
308 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
309 ///
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000310 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
311 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000312 Instruction *InsertBefore);
313
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000314 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
315 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000316 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000317
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000318 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
319 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
320 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
321
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000322 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
323 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000324 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
325 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
326 unsigned Depth = 0);
327
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000328 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
329 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
330
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000331 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
332 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
333 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
334 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
335
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000336 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
337 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
338 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
339 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000340 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
341
342
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000343 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
344 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000345
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000346 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000347 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000348 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000349 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +0000350 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(CastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000351 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
352
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000353 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000354 };
Chris Lattnerb28b6802002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000355
Chris Lattnerc2d3d312006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000356 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000357}
358
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000359// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000360// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000361static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
362 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
363 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000364 return 3;
365 return 4;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000366 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000367 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
368 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000369}
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000370
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000371// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
372// it.
373static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000374 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000375}
376
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000377// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
378// though a va_arg area...
379static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000380 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
381 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
382 return Type::Int32Ty;
383 } else if (Ty == Type::FloatTy)
384 return Type::DoubleTy;
385 return Ty;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000386}
387
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000388/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
389/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
390static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
391 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000392 return I->getOperand(0);
393 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000394 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000395 return CE->getOperand(0);
396 return 0;
397}
398
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000399/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
400/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000401static Instruction::CastOps
402isEliminableCastPair(
403 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
404 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
405 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
406 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
407) {
408
409 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
410 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000411
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000412 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
413 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
414 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000415
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000416 return Instruction::CastOps(
417 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
418 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000419}
420
421/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
422/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
423/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000424static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
425 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000426 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
427
Chris Lattner99155be2006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000428 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000429 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000430 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000431 return false;
432 return true;
433}
434
435/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
436/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
437/// casts that are known to not do anything...
438///
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000439Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
440 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000441 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
442 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
443 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000444 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000445
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000446 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner1d441ad2006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000447}
448
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000449// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
450// operators:
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000451//
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000452// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
453// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
454// binary operators.
455//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000456// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
457// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000458//
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000459bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000460 bool Changed = false;
461 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
462 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000463
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000464 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
465 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000466 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
467 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
468 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000469 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
470 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
471 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000472 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
473 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
474 return true;
475 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
476 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
477 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
478 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
479 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
480
481 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner34428442003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000482 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000483 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
484 Op1->getOperand(0),
485 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000486 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000487 I.setOperand(0, New);
488 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
489 return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000490 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000491 }
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000492 return Changed;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000493}
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000494
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000495/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
496/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
497/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
498bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
499 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
500 return false;
501 I.swapOperands();
502 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
503 return true;
504}
505
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000506// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
507// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000508//
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000509static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
510 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000511 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000512
Chris Lattner9ad0d552004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000513 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
514 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
515 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000516 return 0;
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000517}
518
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000519static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
520 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000521 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000522
523 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000524 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +0000525 return ConstantExpr::getNot(C);
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000526 return 0;
527}
528
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000529// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
530// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000531// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
532// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000533//
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000534static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000535 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000536 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000538 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000539 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000540 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner970136362004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000541 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000542 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000543 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
544 CST = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getShl(One, CST));
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000545 return I->getOperand(0);
546 }
547 }
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000548 return 0;
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000549}
Chris Lattner31ae8632002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000550
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000551/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
552/// expression, return it.
553static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
554 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
555 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
556 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
557 return cast<User>(V);
558 return false;
559}
560
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000561/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000562static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000563 APInt Val(C->getValue());
564 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000565}
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000566/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000567static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000568 APInt Val(C->getValue());
569 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000570}
571/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
572static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
573 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
574}
575/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
576static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
577 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
578}
579/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
580static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
581 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
582}
583/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
584static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
585 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000586}
587
Chris Lattner4534dd592006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000588/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
589/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000590/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
591/// processing.
592/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
593/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
594/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
595/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
596/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
597/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000598static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000599 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000600 assert(V && "No Value?");
601 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000602 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000603 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000604 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000605 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000606 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000607 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
608 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000609 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000610 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
611 return;
612 }
613
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000614 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
615 return; // Limit search depth.
616
617 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
618 if (!I) return;
619
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000620 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000621 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000622
623 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000624 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000625 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
626 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000627 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
628 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000629 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
630 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
631
632 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
633 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
634 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
635 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
636 return;
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000637 }
638 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000639 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000640 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
641 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000642 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
643 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
644
645 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
646 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
647 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
648 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
649 return;
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000650 }
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000651 case Instruction::Xor: {
652 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
653 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
654 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
655 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
656
657 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
658 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
659 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
660 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
661 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
662 return;
663 }
664 case Instruction::Select:
665 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
666 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
667 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
668 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
669
670 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
671 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
672 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
673 return;
674 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
675 case Instruction::FPExt:
676 case Instruction::FPToUI:
677 case Instruction::FPToSI:
678 case Instruction::SIToFP:
679 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
680 case Instruction::UIToFP:
681 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
682 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000683 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000684 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000685 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
686 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000687 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
688 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
689 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
690 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
691 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000692 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
693 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000694 return;
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000695 }
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000696 case Instruction::BitCast: {
697 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
698 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
699 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
700 return;
701 }
702 break;
703 }
704 case Instruction::ZExt: {
705 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
706 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000707 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000708
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000709 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
710 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
711 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
712 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
713 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000714 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
715 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000716 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
717 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000718 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000719 return;
720 }
721 case Instruction::SExt: {
722 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
723 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000724 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000725
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000726 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
727 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
728 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
729 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
730 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000731 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Shengaf4341d2007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000732 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
733 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000734
735 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
736 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000737 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
738 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000739 KnownZero |= NewBits;
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000740 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000741 KnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000742 return;
743 }
744 case Instruction::Shl:
745 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
746 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
747 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000748 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
749 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000750 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Shengb3e00c42007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000751 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
752 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000753 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000754 return;
755 }
756 break;
757 case Instruction::LShr:
758 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
759 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
760 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
761 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000762
763 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000764 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
765 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000766 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
767 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
768 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000769 // high bits known zero.
770 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000771 return;
772 }
773 break;
774 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000775 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000776 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
777 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
778 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000779
780 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencerd8aad612007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000781 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
782 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000783 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
784 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
785 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
786
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000787 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
788 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000789 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Sheng57e3f732007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000790 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000791 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spenceraa696402007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000792 return;
793 }
794 break;
795 }
796}
797
Reid Spencerbb5741f2007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000798/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
799/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
800/// for bits that V cannot have.
801static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengbe171ee2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000802 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencerbb5741f2007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000803 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
804 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
805 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
806}
807
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000808/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
809/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
810/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
811/// constant and return true.
812static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencerd9281782007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000813 APInt Demanded) {
814 assert(I && "No instruction?");
815 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
816
817 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
818 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
819 if (!OpC) return false;
820
821 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
822 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
823 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
824 return false;
825
826 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
827 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
828 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
829 return true;
830}
831
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000832// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
833// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
834// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
835// min/max.
836static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000837 const APInt& KnownZero,
838 const APInt& KnownOne,
839 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
840 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
841 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
842 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
843 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
844 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000845 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000846
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000847 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000848
849 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
850 // bit if it is unknown.
851 Min = KnownOne;
852 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
853
Zhou Shengc2d33092007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000854 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000855 Min |= SignBit;
856 Max &= ~SignBit;
857 }
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000858}
859
860// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
861// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
862// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
863// min/max.
864static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000865 const APInt& KnownZero,
866 const APInt& KnownOne,
867 APInt& Min,
868 APInt& Max) {
869 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
870 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
871 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
872 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
873 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000874 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000875
876 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
877 Min = KnownOne;
878 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
879 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
880}
Chris Lattner0157e7f2006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000881
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000882/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
883/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
884/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
885/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
886/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
887/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
888/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
889/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
890/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
891/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
892/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
893/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
894/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
895/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
896/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
897bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
898 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
899 unsigned Depth) {
900 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
901 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
902 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
903 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
904 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
905 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
906 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
907 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
908 must have same BitWidth");
909 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
910 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
911 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
912 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
913 return false;
914 }
915
Zhou Shengb9128442007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000916 KnownZero.clear();
917 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000918 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
919 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
920 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
921 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
922 return false;
923 }
924 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
925 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
926 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
927 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
928 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
930 return false;
931 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
932 return false;
933 }
934
935 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
936 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
937
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000938 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
939 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
940 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
941 default: break;
942 case Instruction::And:
943 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
944 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
945 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
946 return true;
947 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
948 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
949
950 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
951 // LHS.
952 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
953 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
954 return true;
955 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
956 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
957
958 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
959 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
960 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
961 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
962 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
963 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
964 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
965 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
966
967 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
968 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
969 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
970
971 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
972 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
973 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
974
975 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
976 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
977 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
978 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
979 break;
980 case Instruction::Or:
981 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
982 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
983 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
984 return true;
985 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
986 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
987 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
988 // LHS.
989 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
990 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
991 return true;
992 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
993 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
994
995 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
996 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
997 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
998 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
999 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1000 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1001 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1002 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1003
1004 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1005 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1006 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1007 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1008 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1009 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1010 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1011 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1012
1013 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1014 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1015 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1016
1017 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1018 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1019 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1020 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1021 break;
1022 case Instruction::Xor: {
1023 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1024 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1025 return true;
1026 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1027 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1028 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1029 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1030 return true;
1031 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1032 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1033
1034 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1035 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1036 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1037 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1038 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1039 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1040
1041 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1042 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1043 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1044 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1045 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1046 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1047
1048 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1049 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1050 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1051 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1052 Instruction *Or =
1053 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1054 I->getName());
1055 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1056 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1057 }
1058
1059 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1060 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1061 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1062 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1063 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1064 // all known
1065 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1066 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1067 Instruction *And =
1068 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1069 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1070 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1071 }
1072 }
1073
1074 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1075 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1076 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1077 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1078
1079 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1080 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1081 break;
1082 }
1083 case Instruction::Select:
1084 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1085 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1086 return true;
1087 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1088 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1089 return true;
1090 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1091 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1092 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1093 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1094
1095 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1096 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1097 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1098 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1099 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1100
1101 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1102 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1103 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1104 break;
1105 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1106 uint32_t truncBf =
1107 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
1108 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask.zext(truncBf),
1109 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf), RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf), Depth+1))
1110 return true;
1111 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1112 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1113 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1114 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1115 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1116 break;
1117 }
1118 case Instruction::BitCast:
1119 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1120 return false;
1121
1122 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1123 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1124 return true;
1125 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1126 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1127 break;
1128 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1129 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1130 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001131 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
1132 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001133
1134 DemandedMask &= SrcTy->getMask().zext(BitWidth);
1135 uint32_t zextBf = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
1136 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask.trunc(zextBf),
1137 RHSKnownZero.trunc(zextBf), RHSKnownOne.trunc(zextBf), Depth+1))
1138 return true;
1139 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1140 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1141 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1142 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1143 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1144 // The top bits are known to be zero.
1145 RHSKnownZero |= NewBits;
1146 break;
1147 }
1148 case Instruction::SExt: {
1149 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1150 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencercd99fbd2007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001151 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
1152 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001153
1154 // Get the sign bit for the source type
1155 APInt InSignBit(APInt::getSignBit(SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
1156 InSignBit.zext(BitWidth);
1157 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
1158 SrcTy->getMask().zext(BitWidth);
1159
1160 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1161 // bit is demanded.
1162 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
1163 InputDemandedBits |= InSignBit;
1164
1165 uint32_t sextBf = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
1166 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits.trunc(sextBf),
1167 RHSKnownZero.trunc(sextBf), RHSKnownOne.trunc(sextBf), Depth+1))
1168 return true;
1169 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1170 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1171 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1172 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1173 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1174
1175 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1176 // top bits of the result.
1177
1178 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1179 // convert this into a zero extension.
1180 if ((RHSKnownZero & InSignBit) != 0 || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
1181 {
1182 // Convert to ZExt cast
1183 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1184 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
1185 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & InSignBit) != 0) { // Input sign bit known set
1186 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
1187 RHSKnownZero &= ~NewBits;
1188 } else { // Input sign bit unknown
1189 RHSKnownZero &= ~NewBits;
1190 RHSKnownOne &= ~NewBits;
1191 }
1192 break;
1193 }
1194 case Instruction::Add: {
1195 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1196 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1197 // either.
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001198 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001199
1200 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1201 // we can do.
1202 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1203 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1204 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1205 if (RHS->isZero())
1206 break;
1207
1208 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1209 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
1210 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth).lshr(NLZ));
1211
1212 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1213 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1214 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1215 return true;
1216
1217 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1218 // the constant.
1219 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1220 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1221
1222 // Avoid excess work.
1223 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1224 break;
1225
1226 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1227 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1228 Instruction *Or =
1229 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1230 I->getName());
1231 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1232 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1233 }
1234
1235 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1236 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1237 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1238 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1239 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1240
1241 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1242 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1243 // this scan.
1244 APInt RHSVal(RHS->getValue());
1245
1246 bool CarryIn = false;
1247 APInt CarryBits(BitWidth, 0);
1248 const uint64_t *LHSKnownZeroRawVal = LHSKnownZero.getRawData(),
1249 *RHSRawVal = RHSVal.getRawData();
1250 for (uint32_t i = 0; i != RHSVal.getNumWords(); ++i) {
1251 uint64_t AddVal = ~LHSKnownZeroRawVal[i] + RHSRawVal[i],
1252 XorVal = ~LHSKnownZeroRawVal[i] ^ RHSRawVal[i];
1253 uint64_t WordCarryBits = AddVal ^ XorVal + CarryIn;
1254 if (AddVal < RHSRawVal[i])
1255 CarryIn = true;
1256 else
1257 CarryIn = false;
1258 CarryBits.setWordToValue(i, WordCarryBits);
1259 }
1260
1261 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1262
1263 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1264 // other, and there is no input carry.
1265 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1266 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1267
1268 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1269 // is no input carry.
1270 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1271 } else {
1272 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1273 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
1274 if ((DemandedMask & APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)) == 0) {
1275 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1276 // significant bit and all those below it.
1277 APInt DemandedFromOps = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth).lshr(NLZ);
1278 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1279 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1280 return true;
1281 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1282 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1283 return true;
1284 }
1285 }
1286 break;
1287 }
1288 case Instruction::Sub:
1289 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1290 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
1291 if ((DemandedMask & APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)) == 0) {
1292 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1293 // significant bit and all those below it.
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001294 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001295 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth).lshr(NLZ));
1296 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1297 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1298 return true;
1299 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1300 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1301 return true;
1302 }
1303 break;
1304 case Instruction::Shl:
1305 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1306 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
1307 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt),
1308 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1309 return true;
1310 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1311 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1312 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1313 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1314 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001315 if (ShiftAmt)
1316 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getAllOnesValue(ShiftAmt).zextOrCopy(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001317 }
1318 break;
1319 case Instruction::LShr:
1320 // For a logical shift right
1321 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1322 unsigned ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
1323
1324 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
1325 // Unsigned shift right.
1326 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
1327 (DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt)) & TypeMask,
1328 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1329 return true;
1330 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1331 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001332 RHSKnownZero &= TypeMask;
1333 RHSKnownOne &= TypeMask;
1334 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1335 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001336 if (ShiftAmt) {
1337 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
1338 APInt HighBits(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth).shl(
1339 BitWidth - ShiftAmt));
1340 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1341 }
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001342 }
1343 break;
1344 case Instruction::AShr:
1345 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1346 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1347 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1348 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1349 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1350 // Perform the logical shift right.
1351 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1352 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1353 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1354 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1355 }
1356
1357 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1358 unsigned ShiftAmt = SA->getZExtValue();
1359
1360 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
1361 // Signed shift right.
1362 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
1363 (DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt)) & TypeMask,
1364 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1365 return true;
1366 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1367 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1368 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Shengd8c645b2007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001369 APInt HighBits(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth).shl(BitWidth - ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer1791f232007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001370 RHSKnownZero &= TypeMask;
1371 RHSKnownOne &= TypeMask;
1372 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1373 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1374
1375 // Handle the sign bits.
1376 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1377 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1378 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1379
1380 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1381 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
1382 if ((RHSKnownZero & SignBit) != 0 ||
1383 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1384 // Perform the logical shift right.
1385 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1386 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1387 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1388 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1389 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1390 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1391 }
1392 }
1393 break;
1394 }
1395
1396 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1397 // constant.
1398 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1399 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1400 return false;
1401}
1402
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001403
1404/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1405/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1406/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1407/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1408///
1409/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1410/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1411/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1412Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1413 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1414 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001415 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001416 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1417 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1418 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1419 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1420
1421 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1422 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1423 UndefElts = EltMask;
1424 return 0;
1425 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1426 UndefElts = EltMask;
1427 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1428 }
1429
1430 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001431 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1432 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001433 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1434
1435 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1436 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1437 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1438 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1439 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1440 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1441 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1442 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1443 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1444 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1445 }
1446
1447 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001448 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001449 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1450 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001451 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001452 // set to undef.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001453 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001454 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1455 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1456 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1457 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1458 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1459 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001460 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001461 }
1462
1463 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1464 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1465 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1466 return false;
1467 }
1468 return false;
1469 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1470 return false;
1471 }
1472
1473 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1474 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1475
1476 bool MadeChange = false;
1477 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1478 Value *TmpV;
1479 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1480 default: break;
1481
1482 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1483 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1484 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001485 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001486 if (Idx == 0) {
1487 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1488 // which elt is getting updated.
1489 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1490 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1491 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1492 break;
1493 }
1494
1495 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1496 // insertelement.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001497 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001498 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1499 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1500
1501 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1502 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1503 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1504 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1505 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1506 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1507
1508 // The inserted element is defined.
1509 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1510 break;
1511 }
1512
1513 case Instruction::And:
1514 case Instruction::Or:
1515 case Instruction::Xor:
1516 case Instruction::Add:
1517 case Instruction::Sub:
1518 case Instruction::Mul:
1519 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1520 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1521 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1522 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1523 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1524 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1525 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1526
1527 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1528 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1529 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1530 break;
1531
1532 case Instruction::Call: {
1533 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1534 if (!II) break;
1535 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1536 default: break;
1537
1538 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1539 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1540 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1541 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1542 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1543 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1544 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1545 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1546 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1547 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1548 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1549 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1550 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1551 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1552 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1553 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1554
1555 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1556 // scalarize it now.
1557 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1558 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1559 default: break;
1560 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1561 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1562 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1563 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1564 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1565 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1566 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1567 // Extract the element as scalars.
1568 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1569 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1570
1571 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1572 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1573 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1574 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1575 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1576 II->getName()), *II);
1577 break;
1578 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1579 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1580 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1581 II->getName()), *II);
1582 break;
1583 }
1584
1585 Instruction *New =
1586 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1587 II->getName());
1588 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1589 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1590 return New;
1591 }
1592 }
1593
1594 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1595 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1596 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1597 break;
1598 }
1599 break;
1600 }
1601 }
1602 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1603}
1604
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001605/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1606/// true when both operands are equal...
1607/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true if both operands are equal
1608static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1609 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = ICI.getPredicate();
1610 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1611 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1612 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1613}
1614
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001615/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1616/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1617/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1618/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1619/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1620/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1621/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1622///
1623template<typename Functor>
1624Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1625 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1626 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1627
1628 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1629 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1630 return F.apply(Root);
1631
1632 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1633 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001634 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001635 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1636 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1637
1638 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1639 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1640 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1641 ShouldApply = true;
1642 }
1643
1644 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1645 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1646 if (ShouldApply) {
1647 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001648
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001649 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1650 // and perform the reassociation.
1651 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1652
1653 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1654 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1655
1656 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1657 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001658 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner8953b902004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001659 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1660 return 0;
1661 }
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001662 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001663 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001664 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1665 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1666 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1667 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001668
1669 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1670 // get to LHSI.
1671 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1672 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner284d3b02004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001673 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1674 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1675 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1676 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1677 ARI = NextLHSI;
1678
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001679 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1680 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1681 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1682 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1683 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001684
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001685 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1686 // the transformation...
1687 return F.apply(Root);
1688 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001689
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001690 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1691 }
1692 return 0;
1693}
1694
1695
1696// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1697struct AddRHS {
1698 Value *RHS;
1699 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1700 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1701 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001702 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001703 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001704 }
1705};
1706
1707// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1708// iff C1&C2 == 0
1709struct AddMaskingAnd {
1710 Constant *C2;
1711 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1712 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001713 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001714 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001715 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001716 }
1717 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001718 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001719 }
1720};
1721
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001722static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001723 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001724 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001725 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001726 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001727
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001728 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1729 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001730 }
1731
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001732 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001733 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1734 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001735
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001736 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1737 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001738 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1739 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001740 }
1741
1742 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1743 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1744 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1745 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001746 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1747 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001748 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1749 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1750 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001751 else {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001752 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattnerf9d96652004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001753 abort();
1754 }
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001755 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1756}
1757
1758// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1759// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1760// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1761// not have a second operand.
1762static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1763 InstCombiner *IC) {
1764 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1765 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1766 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1767 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1768
1769 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001770 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001771 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner374e6592005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001772
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001773 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1774 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1775
1776 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1777 SelectFalseVal);
1778 }
1779 return 0;
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001780}
1781
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001782
1783/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1784/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1785/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1786Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1787 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001788 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001789 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001790
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001791 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1792 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerc4d8e7e2007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001793 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001794 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1795 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1796 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1797 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerc4d8e7e2007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001798 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001799 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1800
1801 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1802 // loop.
1803 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1804 return 0;
1805 }
1806
1807 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1808 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1809 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1810 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1811 if (NonConstBB) {
1812 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1813 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1814 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001815
1816 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001817 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001818 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001819 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001820 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001821
1822 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1823 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1824 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001825 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001826 Value *InV;
1827 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001828 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1829 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1830 else
1831 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001832 } else {
1833 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1834 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1835 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1836 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1837 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001838 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1839 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1840 CI->getPredicate(),
1841 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1842 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001843 else
1844 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1845
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001846 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001847 }
1848 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001849 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001850 } else {
1851 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1852 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001853 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001854 Value *InV;
1855 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001856 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001857 } else {
1858 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001859 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1860 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1861 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001862 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner04689872006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001863 }
1864 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001865 }
1866 }
1867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1868}
1869
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001870Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001871 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001872 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001873
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001874 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001875 // X + undef -> undef
1876 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1877 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1878
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001879 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001880 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner7fde91e2005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001881 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1882 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattnerda1b1522005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001883 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
1884 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(-0.0))
1885 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner7fde91e2005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001886 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001887
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001888 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001889 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001890 APInt Val(CI->getValue());
1891 unsigned BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
1892 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001893 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner6e2c15c2006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001894
1895 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1896 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001897 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1898 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1899 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1900 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1901 return &I;
1902 }
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001903 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001904
1905 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1906 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1907 return NV;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001908
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001909 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1910 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattner4284f642007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001911 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1912 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001913 unsigned TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001914 APInt RHSVal(cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue());
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001915
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001916 unsigned Size = TySizeBits / 2;
1917 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1918 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001919 do {
1920 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001921 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1922 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001923 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1924 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001925 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001926 APInt Mask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(TySizeBits));
1927 Mask <<= Size;
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00001928 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001929 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001930 break;
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001931 }
1932 }
1933 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001934 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
1935 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
1936 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001937
Reid Spencera5c18bf2007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001938 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
1939 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
1940 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
1941 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
1942 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
1943 switch (Size) {
1944 default: break;
1945 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
1946 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
1947 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
1948 }
1949 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00001950 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001951 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencera5c18bf2007-03-28 01:36:16 +00001952 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner0b3557f2005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001953 }
1954 }
Chris Lattnercf4a9962004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001955 }
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001956
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001957 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00001958 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001959 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00001960
1961 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
1962 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1963 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
1964 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
1965 }
1966 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
1967 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
1968 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
1969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
1970 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +00001971 }
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00001972
Chris Lattner147e9752002-05-08 22:46:53 +00001973 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001974 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001975 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001976
1977 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00001978 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
1979 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001980 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00001981
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001982
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00001983 ConstantInt *C2;
1984 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
1985 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
1986 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
1987
1988 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
1989 ConstantInt *C1;
1990 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00001991 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00001992 }
1993
1994 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00001995 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
1996 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
1997
Chris Lattner23eb8ec2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00001998 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
1999 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
2000 dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2001 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
2002
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002003
Chris Lattnerb8b97502003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002004 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002005 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattner23eb8ec2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002006 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2007 return R;
Chris Lattner7fb29e12003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002008
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002009 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002010 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002011 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
2012 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002013
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002014 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2015 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002016 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002017 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2018 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2019 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002020 APInt AddRHSV(CRHS->getValue());
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002021
2022 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002023 APInt AddRHSHighBits = ~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1);
2024 AddRHSHighBits &= C2->getType()->getMask();
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002025
2026 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002027 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd = AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue();
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002028
Chris Lattnerbff91d92004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002029 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2030 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2031 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2032 LHS->getName()), I);
2033 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2034 }
2035 }
2036 }
2037
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002038 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2039 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002040 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002041 return R;
Chris Lattnerb9cde762003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002042 }
2043
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002044 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
2045 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
2046 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002047 {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002048 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2049 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002050 if (!CI) {
2051 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2052 Other = LHS;
2053 }
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002054 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002055 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2056 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002057 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002058 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002059 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth44cb67a2006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002060 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002061 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth4f339be2006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002062 }
2063 }
2064
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002065 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002066}
2067
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002068// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2069// highest order bit set.
2070static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002071 unsigned NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002072 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattnerbdb0ce02003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002073}
2074
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002075Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002076 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002077
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002078 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2079 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002080
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002081 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002082 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002083 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattner9fa53de2002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002084
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002085 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2086 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2087 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2088 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2089
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002090 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2091 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002092 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2093 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002094
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002095 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002096 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002097 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002098 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2099
Chris Lattner27df1db2007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002100 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2101 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002102 if (C->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002103 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002104 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002105 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002106 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002107 if (CU->getZExtValue() ==
2108 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002109 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002110 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2111 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner92295c52004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002112 }
2113 }
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002114 }
2115 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2116 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2117 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
2118 if (CU->getZExtValue() ==
2119 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002120 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002121 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002122 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002123 }
2124 }
2125 }
Chris Lattner022167f2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002126 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002127
2128 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2129 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002130 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002131 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002132
2133 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2134 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2135 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002136 }
2137
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002138 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2139 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002140 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002141 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002142 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002143 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002144 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002145 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2146 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2147 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002148 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattnerc7f3c1a2005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002149 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2150 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002151 }
2152
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002153 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002154 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2155 // is not used by anyone else...
2156 //
Chris Lattnerc2f0aa52004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002157 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002158 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002159 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2160 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2161 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2162 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002163
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002164 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002165 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002166 }
2167
2168 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2169 //
2170 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2171 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2172 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2173
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002174 Value *NewNot =
2175 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002176 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002177 }
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002178
Reid Spencer3c514952006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002179 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002180 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002181 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002182 if (CSI->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002183 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002184 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner0aee4b72004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002185 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2186
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002187 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002188 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002189 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002190 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002191 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002192 }
Chris Lattnerad3c4952002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002193 }
Chris Lattnera9be4492005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002194 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002195
Chris Lattner7a002fe2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002196 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002197 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2198 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002199 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2200 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2201 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner47060462005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002203 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2204 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2205 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002206 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002207
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002208 ConstantInt *C1;
2209 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002210 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2211 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattner57c8d992003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002212
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002213 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2214 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002215 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner8c3e7b92004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002216 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002217 return 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002218}
2219
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002220/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if it
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002221/// really just returns true if the most significant (sign) bit is set.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002222static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS) {
2223 switch (pred) {
2224 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
2225 // True if LHS s< RHS and RHS == 0
2226 return RHS->isNullValue();
2227 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
2228 // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2229 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
2230 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2231 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002232 return RHS->getValue() ==
2233 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002234 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2235 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002236 return RHS->getValue() ==
2237 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002238 default:
2239 return false;
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002240 }
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002241}
2242
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002243Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002244 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002245 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002246
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002247 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2248 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2249
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002250 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002251 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2252 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002253
2254 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002255 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerede3fe02003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002256 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2257 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002258 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2259 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002260
Chris Lattnercce81be2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002261 if (CI->isNullValue())
2262 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2263 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2264 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2265 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner35236d82003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002266 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002267
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002268 APInt Val(cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue());
2269 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002270 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002271 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002272 }
Robert Bocchino7b5b86c2004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002273 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002274 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2275 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner31ba1292002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002276
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002277 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2278 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2279 if (Op1F->getValue() == 1.0)
2280 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2281 }
Chris Lattner32c01df2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002282
2283 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2284 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2285 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2286 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2287 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2288 Op1, "tmp");
2289 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2290 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2291 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2292 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2293
2294 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002295
2296 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2297 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002298 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002299 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002300
2301 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2302 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2303 return NV;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002304 }
2305
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002306 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2307 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002308 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattner934a64cf2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002309
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002310 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2311 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2312 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2313 // formed.
2314 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002315 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002316 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002317 BoolCast = CI;
2318 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002319 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002320 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002321 BoolCast = CI;
2322 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002323 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002324 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2325 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
2326
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002327 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002328 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2329 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002330 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1))) {
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002331 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002332 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002333 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002334 Value *V =
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002335 InsertNewInstBefore(
2336 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattnere79e8542004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002337 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2338 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002339
2340 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2341 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002342 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
2343 unsigned SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2344 unsigned DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2345 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2346 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2347 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2348 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2349 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002350
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002351 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002352 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattner2635b522004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002353 }
2354 }
2355 }
2356
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002357 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002358}
2359
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002360/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2361/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2362/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2363/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002364Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002365 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002366
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002367 // undef / X -> 0
2368 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002369 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002370
2371 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002372 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002374
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002375 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002376 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2377 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002378 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2379 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002380 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002381 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002382 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2383 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2384 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2385 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002386 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002387 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2388 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2389 else
2390 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2391 return &I;
2392 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002393
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002394 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2395 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2396 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2397 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2398 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002399 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002400 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2401 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2402 else
2403 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2404 return &I;
2405 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002406 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002407
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002408 return 0;
2409}
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002410
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002411/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2412/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2413/// division instructions.
2414/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002415Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002416 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2417
2418 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2419 return Common;
2420
2421 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2422 // div X, 1 == X
2423 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2424 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2425
2426 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2427 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2428 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2429 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2430 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002431 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattner42362612005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002432 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002433
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002434 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002435 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2436 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2437 return R;
2438 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2439 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2440 return NV;
2441 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002442 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002443
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002444 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002445 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002446 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2448
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002449 return 0;
2450}
2451
2452Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2453 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2454
2455 // Handle the integer div common cases
2456 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2457 return Common;
2458
2459 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2460 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2461 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2462 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002463 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002464 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002465 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002466 }
2467
2468 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002469 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002470 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2471 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002472 APInt C1(cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue());
2473 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002474 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002475 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002476 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002477 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2478 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002479 }
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002480 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002481 }
2482 }
Chris Lattnerdd0c1742005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002483 }
2484
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002485 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2486 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002487 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002488 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002489 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002490 APInt TVA(STO->getValue()), FVA(SFO->getValue());
2491 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002492 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002493 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002494 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2495 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2496 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2497 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2498 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2499
2500 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2501 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2502 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2503 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2504 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002505
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002506 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2507 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002508 }
Reid Spencer3939b1a2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002509 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002510 return 0;
2511}
2512
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002513Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2514 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2515
2516 // Handle the integer div common cases
2517 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2518 return Common;
2519
2520 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2521 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2522 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2523 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2524
2525 // -X/C -> X/-C
2526 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2527 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2528 }
2529
2530 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2531 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002532 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002533 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002534 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2535 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2536 }
2537 }
2538
2539 return 0;
2540}
2541
2542Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2543 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2544}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002545
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002546/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2547/// of some factor, return that factor.
2548static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2549 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2550 return CI;
2551
2552 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2553 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2554
2555 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2556 if (!I) return Result;
2557
2558 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2559 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2560 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2561 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2562 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2563 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2564 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2565 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2566 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2567 }
2568 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2569 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2570 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002571 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002572 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2573 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002574 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002575 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002576 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002577 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002578 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2579 return Result;
2580 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2581 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002582 }
2583 return Result;
2584}
2585
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002586/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2587/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2588/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2589/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2590Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002591 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002592
Chris Lattner0de4a8d2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002593 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2594 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2595 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2596 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2597
2598 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2599 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2600 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2601 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002602
2603 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2604 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2605 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2606 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2607 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2608 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2609 // simplified also.
2610 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2611 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2612 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2613 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002614 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002615 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2616 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2617 else
2618 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002619 return &I;
2620 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002621 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2622 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2623 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2624 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2625 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002626 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002627 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2628 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2629 else
2630 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2631 return &I;
2632 }
Chris Lattnere9ff0ea2005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002633 }
Chris Lattner7fd5f072004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002634
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002635 return 0;
2636}
2637
2638/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2639/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2640/// remainder instructions.
2641/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2642Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2643 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2644
2645 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2646 return common;
2647
Chris Lattnerbf5b7cf2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002648 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner0de4a8d2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002649 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2650 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2651 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2652
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002653 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2654 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2655
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002656 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2657 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2658 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2659 return R;
2660 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2661 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2662 return NV;
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002663 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002664 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2665 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattner85dda9a2006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002666 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerb70f1412006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002667 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002668 }
2669
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002670 return 0;
2671}
2672
2673Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2674 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2675
2676 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2677 return common;
2678
2679 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2680 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2681 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2682 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2683 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002684 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002685 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2686 }
2687
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002688 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002689 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2690 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2691 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002692 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002693 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2694 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2695 "tmp"), I);
2696 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2697 }
2698 }
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002699 }
Chris Lattnerd79dc792006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002700
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002701 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2702 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2703 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2704 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2705 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2706 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002707 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2708 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002709 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2710 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2711 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2712 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2713 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2714 }
2715 }
Chris Lattner2e90b732006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002716 }
2717
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002718 return 0;
2719}
2720
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002721Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2722 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2723
2724 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2725 return common;
2726
2727 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2728 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002729 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002730 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2731 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2732 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2733 return &I;
2734 }
2735
2736 // If the top bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2737 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Reid Spencer6d392062007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002738 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002739 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2740 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2741 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2742 }
2743
2744 return 0;
2745}
2746
2747Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002748 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2749}
2750
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002751// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002752static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002753 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002754 if (isSigned) {
2755 // Calculate 0111111111..11111
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002756 APInt Val(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits));
2757 return C->getValue() == Val-1;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002758 }
Reid Spenceref599b02007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002759 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002760}
2761
2762// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002763static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
2764 if (isSigned) {
2765 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
Reid Spencer3b93db72007-03-19 21:08:07 +00002766 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2767 APInt Val(APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits));
2768 return C->getValue() == Val+1;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002769 }
Reid Spencer3b93db72007-03-19 21:08:07 +00002770 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002771}
2772
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002773// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2774// constant.
2775static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer66827212007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002776 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002777}
2778
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002779// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2780// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2781static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Shengb3949342007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002782 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002783}
2784
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002785/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002786/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2787///
2788/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2789///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002790/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2791/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002792///
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002793/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2794/// 0 A > B
2795/// 1 A == B
2796/// 2 A < B
2797///
2798/// <=> Value Definition
2799/// 000 0 Always false
2800/// 001 1 A > B
2801/// 010 2 A == B
2802/// 011 3 A >= B
2803/// 100 4 A < B
2804/// 101 5 A != B
2805/// 110 6 A <= B
2806/// 111 7 Always true
2807///
2808static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2809 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002810 // False -> 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002811 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2812 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2813 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2814 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2815 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2816 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2817 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2818 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2819 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2820 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002821 // True -> 7
2822 default:
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002823 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002824 return 0;
2825 }
2826}
2827
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002828/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2829/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
2830/// new /// ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
2831/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2832static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2833 switch (code) {
2834 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002835 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002836 case 1:
2837 if (sign)
2838 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2839 else
2840 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2841 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2842 case 3:
2843 if (sign)
2844 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2845 else
2846 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2847 case 4:
2848 if (sign)
2849 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2850 else
2851 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2852 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2853 case 6:
2854 if (sign)
2855 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2856 else
2857 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002858 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002859 }
2860}
2861
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002862static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2863 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2864 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2865 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2866 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2867 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2868}
2869
2870namespace {
2871// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2872struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002873 InstCombiner &IC;
2874 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002875 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2876 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2877 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2878 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002879 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002880 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2881 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2882 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2883 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002884 return false;
2885 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002886 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2887 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2888 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2889 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2890 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002891 }
2892
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002893 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002894 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002895 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002896 unsigned Code;
2897 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2898 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2899 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2900 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner2caaaba2003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002901 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002902 }
2903
Chris Lattnerd1bce952007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002904 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
2905 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
2906
2907 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002908 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2909 return I;
2910 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
2911 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
2912 }
2913};
Chris Lattnere3a63d12006-11-15 04:53:24 +00002914} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002915
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002916// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
2917// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002918// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002919Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002920 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
2921 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002922 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
2923 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerfcf21a72004-01-12 19:47:05 +00002924 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002925 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002926 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002927
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002928 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
2929 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002930 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002931 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002932 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002933 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002934 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002935 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002936 }
2937 break;
2938 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002939 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
2940 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002941
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002942 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
2943 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002944 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002945 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002946 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002947 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002948 }
2949 break;
2950 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002951 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002952 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
2953 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
2954 // single bit constant.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00002955 APInt AndRHSV(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue());
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002956
2957 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002958 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002959 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
2960 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
2961 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00002962 APInt AddRHS(cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002963
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002964 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
2965 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
2966 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
2967 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
2968 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
2969 // no effect.
2970 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
2971 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
2972 return &TheAnd;
2973 } else {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002974 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002975 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002976 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00002977 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002978 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002979 }
2980 }
2981 }
2982 }
2983 break;
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002984
2985 case Instruction::Shl: {
2986 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
2987 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
2988 //
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002989 Constant *AllOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002990 Constant *ShlMask = ConstantExpr::getShl(AllOne, OpRHS);
2991 Constant *CI = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002992
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00002993 if (CI == ShlMask) { // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
2994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
2995 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00002996 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
2997 return &TheAnd;
2998 }
2999 break;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003000 }
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003001 case Instruction::LShr:
3002 {
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003003 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3004 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3005 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3006 //
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003007 Constant *AllOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003008 Constant *ShrMask = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AllOne, OpRHS);
3009 Constant *CI = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShrMask);
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003010
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003011 if (CI == ShrMask) { // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
3012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3013 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3014 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3015 return &TheAnd;
3016 }
3017 break;
3018 }
3019 case Instruction::AShr:
3020 // Signed shr.
3021 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3022 // with an and.
3023 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003024 Constant *AllOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(AndRHS->getType());
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003025 Constant *ShrMask = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AllOne, OpRHS);
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003026 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, ShrMask);
3027 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003028 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003029 // Make the argument unsigned.
3030 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003031 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003032 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003033 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003034 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003035 }
Chris Lattner2da29172003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003036 }
3037 break;
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003038 }
3039 return 0;
3040}
3041
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003042
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003043/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3044/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003045/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3046/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003047/// insert new instructions.
3048Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003049 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3050 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003051 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003052 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003053 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003054
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003055 if (Inside) {
3056 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003057 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003058
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003059 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003060 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003061 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003062 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3063 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3064 }
3065
3066 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3067 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3068 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003069 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003070 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3071 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003072 }
3073
3074 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003075 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003076
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003077 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003078 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003079 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003080 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3081 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3082 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3083 }
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003084
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003085 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3086 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3087 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003088 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003089 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003090 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3091 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003092}
3093
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003094// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3095// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3096// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3097// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003098static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, unsigned &MB, unsigned &ME) {
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003099 APInt V = Val->getValue();
3100 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3101 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003102
3103 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003104 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003105 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencera962d182007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003106 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003107 return true;
3108}
3109
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003110/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3111/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3112/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003113///
3114/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3115/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3116/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3117///
3118/// return (A +/- B).
3119///
3120Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003121 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003122 Instruction &I) {
3123 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3124 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3125 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3126
3127 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3128
3129 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3130 default: return 0;
3131 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer80263aa2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003132 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003133 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003134 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3135 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3136 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003137 break;
3138
3139 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3140 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3141 // is all N is, ignore it.
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +00003142 unsigned MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003143 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003144 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
3145 APInt Mask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003146 Mask = Mask.lshr(BitWidth-MB+1);
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003147 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003148 break;
3149 }
3150 }
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003151 return 0;
3152 case Instruction::Or:
3153 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003154 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003155 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3156 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003157 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003158 break;
3159 return 0;
3160 }
3161
3162 Instruction *New;
3163 if (isSub)
3164 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3165 else
3166 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3167 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3168}
3169
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003170Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003171 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003172 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003173
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003174 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3175 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3176
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003177 // and X, X = X
3178 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003179 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003180
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003181 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003182 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003183 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003184 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3185 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3186 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003187 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer54d5b1b2007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003188 return &I;
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003189 } else {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003190 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner120ab032007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003191 if (CP->isAllOnesValue())
3192 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
3193 }
3194 }
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003195
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003196 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003197 APInt AndRHSMask(AndRHS->getValue());
3198 APInt TypeMask(cast<IntegerType>(Op0->getType())->getMask());
3199 APInt NotAndRHS = AndRHSMask^TypeMask;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003200
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003201 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003202 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003203 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003204 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3205 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3206 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3207 case Instruction::Xor:
3208 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003209 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3210 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3211 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3212 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3213 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3214 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3215 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3216 return BinaryOperator::create(
3217 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003218 }
Chris Lattnerc3ebf402006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003219 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattner9e2c7fa2005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003220 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3221 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3222 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3223 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3224 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3225 return BinaryOperator::create(
3226 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3227 }
3228 }
3229
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003230 break;
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003231 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003232 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3233 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3234 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3235 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3236 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3237 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3238 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003239 break;
3240
3241 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattnerb4b25302005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003242 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3243 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3244 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3245 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3246 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattneraf517572005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003247 break;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003248 }
3249
Chris Lattner16464b32003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003250 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003251 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerba1cb382003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003252 return Res;
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003253 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003254 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3255 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3256 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3257 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003258 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003259 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattnerab2dc4d2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003260 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003261 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3262 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003263 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3264 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3265 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003266 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3267 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3268 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003269 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003270 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003271 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003272 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003273 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3274 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3275 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3276 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattner2dc148e2006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003277 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2c14cf72005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003278 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3279 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3280 }
3281 }
Chris Lattner33217db2003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003282 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003283
3284 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3285 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003286 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003287 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003288 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3289 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3290 return NV;
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003291 }
3292
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003293 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3294 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003295
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003296 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3297 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3298
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003299 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003300 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003301 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3302 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattner49b47ae2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003303 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003304 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3305 }
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003306
3307 {
3308 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003309 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3310 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3311 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3312 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3313 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3314 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003315
3316 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3317 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3318 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3319 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3320 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3321 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3322 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3323 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3324 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3325 }
3326 }
3327 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3328 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3329 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3330 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3331 std::swap(A, B);
3332 }
3333 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3334 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3335 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3336 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3337 }
3338 }
Chris Lattner8b10ab32006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003339 }
3340
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003341 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3342 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3343 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003344 return R;
3345
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003346 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3347 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003348 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3349 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3350 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3351 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3352 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3353 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3354 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3355 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3356 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003357 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003358 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3359 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3360 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3361 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003362 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003363 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3364 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3365 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3366 }
3367
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003368 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003369 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3370 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003371 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3372 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3373 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003374 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3375
3376 switch (LHSCC) {
3377 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003378 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003379 switch (RHSCC) {
3380 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003381 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3382 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3383 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003385 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3386 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3387 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003388 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3389 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003390 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003391 switch (RHSCC) {
3392 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003393 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3394 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3395 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3396 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3397 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3398 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3399 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3400 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3401 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3402 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3403 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003404 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003405 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3406 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003407 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3408 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3409 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3410 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattnerc8fb6de2007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003411 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3412 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003413 }
3414 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3415 }
3416 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003417 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003418 switch (RHSCC) {
3419 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003420 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3421 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003422 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003423 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3424 break;
3425 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3426 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003427 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003428 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3429 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003430 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003431 break;
3432 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003433 switch (RHSCC) {
3434 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003435 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3436 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003437 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003438 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3439 break;
3440 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3441 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003443 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3444 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003445 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003446 break;
3447 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3448 switch (RHSCC) {
3449 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3450 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3451 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3452 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3453 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3454 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3455 break;
3456 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3457 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3458 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3459 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3460 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3461 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3462 true, I);
3463 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3464 break;
3465 }
3466 break;
3467 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3468 switch (RHSCC) {
3469 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3470 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3471 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3472 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3473 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3474 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3475 break;
3476 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3477 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3478 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3479 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3480 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3481 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3482 true, I);
3483 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3484 break;
3485 }
3486 break;
Chris Lattner623826c2004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003487 }
3488 }
3489 }
3490
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003491 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003492 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3493 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3494 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3495 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003496 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003497 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003498 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3499 I.getType(), TD) &&
3500 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3501 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003502 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3503 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3504 I.getName());
3505 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3506 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3507 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003508 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003509
3510 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003511 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3512 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3513 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003514 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3515 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3516 Instruction *NewOp =
3517 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3518 SI1->getOperand(0),
3519 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003520 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3521 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003522 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003523 }
3524
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003525 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003526}
3527
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003528/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3529/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3530/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003531static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003532 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3533 if (I == 0) return true;
3534
3535 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3536 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3537 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3538 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3539
3540 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3541 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003542 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003543 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003544 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue() !=
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003545 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3546 return true;
3547
3548 unsigned DestNo;
3549 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3550 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3551 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3552 } else {
3553 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3554 DestNo = 0;
3555 }
3556
3557 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3558 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3559 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3560 return true;
3561 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3562 return false;
3563 }
3564
3565 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3566 // don't have this.
3567 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3568 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3569 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3570 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3571 return true;
3572 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3573
3574 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003575 if (ShiftAmt->getZExtValue() & 7 ||
3576 ShiftAmt->getZExtValue() > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003577 return true;
3578
3579 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3580 unsigned DestByte;
3581 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003582 if (AndAmt->getZExtValue() == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003583 break;
3584 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3585 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3586
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003587 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003588 unsigned SrcByte;
3589 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3590 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3591 else
3592 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3593
3594 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3595 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3596 return true;
3597
3598 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3599 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3600 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3601 return true;
3602 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3603 return false;
3604}
3605
3606/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3607/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3608Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003609 // We cannot bswap one byte.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003610 if (I.getType() == Type::Int8Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003611 return 0;
3612
3613 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3614 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003615 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00003616 ByteValues.resize(TD->getTypeSize(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003617
3618 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3619 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3620 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3621 return 0;
3622
3623 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3624 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3625 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3626
3627 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3628 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3629 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3630 return 0;
3631
3632 // If they do then *success* we can turn this into a bswap. Figure out what
3633 // bswap to make it into.
3634 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner091b6ea2006-07-11 18:31:26 +00003635 const char *FnName = 0;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003636 if (I.getType() == Type::Int16Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003637 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i16";
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003638 else if (I.getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003639 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i32";
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00003640 else if (I.getType() == Type::Int64Ty)
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003641 FnName = "llvm.bswap.i64";
3642 else
3643 assert(0 && "Unknown integer type!");
Chris Lattnerfbc524f2007-01-07 06:58:05 +00003644 Constant *F = M->getOrInsertFunction(FnName, I.getType(), I.getType(), NULL);
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003645 return new CallInst(F, V);
3646}
3647
3648
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003649Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003650 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003651 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003652
Chris Lattner3a8248f2007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003653 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
3654 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003655
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003656 // or X, X = X
3657 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003659
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003660 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3661 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner3a8248f2007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003662 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3663 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3664 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3665 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3666 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3667 return &I;
3668 }
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003669
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003670 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003671 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003672 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003673 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3674 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003675 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003676 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003677 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003678 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, ConstantExpr::getOr(RHS, C1));
3679 }
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003680
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003681 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3682 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003683 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003684 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003685 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003686 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
3687 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS)));
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003688 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003689
3690 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3691 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003692 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003693 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003694 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3695 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3696 return NV;
Chris Lattner8f0d1562003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003697 }
3698
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003699 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3700 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003701
3702 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3703 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3704 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3705 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3706 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3707 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3708
Chris Lattnerb7845d62006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003709 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3710 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003711 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattnerb7845d62006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003712 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3713 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3714 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerc482a9e2006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003715 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3716 return BSwap;
3717 }
3718
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003719 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3720 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003721 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003722 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3723 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3724 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3725 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003726 }
3727
3728 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3729 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003730 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003731 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3732 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3733 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3734 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattnerb62f5082005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003735 }
3736
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003737 // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003738 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003739 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
3740
3741 if (A == B) // (A & C1)|(A & C2) == A & (C1|C2)
3742 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, ConstantExpr::getOr(C1, C2));
3743
3744
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003745 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3746 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3747 // replace with V+N.
3748 if (C1 == ConstantExpr::getNot(C2)) {
Chris Lattner330628a2006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003749 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0;
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003750 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003751 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3752 // Add commutes, try both ways.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003753 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003754 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003755 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3757 }
3758 // Or commutes, try both ways.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003759 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003760 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3761 // Add commutes, try both ways.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003762 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003763 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003764 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
Chris Lattner01f56c62005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003766 }
3767 }
3768 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003769
3770 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003771 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3772 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3773 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003774 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3775 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3776 Instruction *NewOp =
3777 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3778 SI1->getOperand(0),
3779 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003780 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3781 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003782 }
3783 }
Chris Lattner812aab72003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003784
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003785 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3786 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003788 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003789 } else {
3790 A = 0;
3791 }
Chris Lattner4294cec2005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003792 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003793 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3794 if (Op0 == B)
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003796 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003797
Misha Brukman9c003d82004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003798 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003799 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3800 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3801 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3802 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3803 }
Chris Lattner3e327a42003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003804 }
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003805
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003806 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3807 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3808 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003809 return R;
3810
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003811 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3812 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003813 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3814 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3815 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3816 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3817 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3818 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3819 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3820 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3821 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003822 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003823 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3824 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3825 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3826 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003827 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003828 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3829 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3830 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3831 }
3832
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003833 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003834 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3835 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003836 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3837 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003838 // equal.
3839 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3840
3841 switch (LHSCC) {
3842 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003843 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003844 switch (RHSCC) {
3845 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003846 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003847 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3848 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3849 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3850 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3851 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003852 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003853 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003854 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003855 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
3856 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
3857 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner5c219462005-04-19 06:04:18 +00003858 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003859 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3860 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
3861 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3863 }
3864 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003865 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003866 switch (RHSCC) {
3867 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003868 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
3869 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
3870 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003872 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
3873 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
3874 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003876 }
3877 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003879 switch (RHSCC) {
3880 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003882 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
3884 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
3885 false, I);
3886 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3887 break;
3888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3889 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003890 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003891 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
3892 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003893 }
3894 break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003895 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003896 switch (RHSCC) {
3897 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
3899 break;
3900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
3901 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
3902 false, I);
3903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
3904 break;
3905 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
3907 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
3909 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003910 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003911 break;
3912 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3913 switch (RHSCC) {
3914 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
3916 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
3917 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3918 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
3919 break;
3920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
3921 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003922 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
3924 break;
3925 }
3926 break;
3927 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3928 switch (RHSCC) {
3929 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3930 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
3931 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
3932 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3933 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
3934 break;
3935 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
3936 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003937 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003938 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
3939 break;
3940 }
3941 break;
Chris Lattnerdcf756e2004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003942 }
3943 }
3944 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003945
3946 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003947 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003948 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003949 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
3950 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003951 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003952 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003953 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3954 I.getType(), TD) &&
3955 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3956 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003957 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3958 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3959 I.getName());
3960 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3961 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3962 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003963 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003964
Chris Lattner15212982005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003965
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003966 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003967}
3968
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003969// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
3970struct XorSelf {
3971 Value *RHS;
3972 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
3973 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
3974 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
3975 return &Xor;
3976 }
3977};
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003978
3979
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003980Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattnerdcf240a2003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003981 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003982 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003983
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003984 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3985 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
3986
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003987 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
3988 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
3989 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?");
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc2076352004-02-16 01:20:27 +00003991 }
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003992
3993 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3994 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003995 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3996 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3997 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3998 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3999 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4000 return &I;
4001 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004002
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004003 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004004 // xor (icmp A, B), true = not (icmp A, B) = !icmp A, B
4005 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004006 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && ICI->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004007 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4008 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere5806662003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004009
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004010 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner8f2f5982003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004011 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004012 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4013 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004014 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4015 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004016 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004017 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004018 }
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004019
4020 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y)
4021 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
4022 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4023 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4024 Instruction *NotY =
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004025 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner023a4832004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004026 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4027 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4028 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4029 }
4030 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004031
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004032 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner5b2edb12006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004033 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004034 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004035 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004036 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4037 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4038 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004039 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner0f68fa62003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004040 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004041 }
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004042 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4043 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencerb722f2b2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004044 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004045 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4046 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4047 // NewRHS.
4048 Constant *CommonBits = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
4049 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4050 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004051 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattnerf78df7c2006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004052 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4053 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4054 return &I;
4055 }
Chris Lattner97638592003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004056 }
Chris Lattnerb8d6e402002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004057 }
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004058
4059 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4060 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004061 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004062 return R;
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004063 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4064 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4065 return NV;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004066 }
4067
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004068 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004069 if (X == Op1)
4070 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004071 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004072
Chris Lattnerbb74e222003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004073 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004074 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004075 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner3082c5a2003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004076
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004077
4078 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4079 if (Op1I) {
4080 Value *A, *B;
4081 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4082 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004083 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004084 I.swapOperands();
4085 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004086 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004087 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004088 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004089 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004090 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4091 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4092 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4093 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4094 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4095 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
4096 if (A == Op0) // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004097 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004098 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004099 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4100 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4101 }
Chris Lattnerb36d9082004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004102 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004103 }
4104
4105 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4106 if (Op0I) {
4107 Value *A, *B;
4108 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4109 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4110 std::swap(A, B);
4111 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4112 Instruction *NotB =
4113 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4114 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004115 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004116 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4117 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4118 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4119 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4120 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4121 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4122 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4123 std::swap(A, B);
4124 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattner6cf49142006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004125 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004126 Instruction *N =
4127 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattnerdcd07922006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004128 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4129 }
Chris Lattner1bbb7b62003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004130 }
Chris Lattner07418422007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004131 }
4132
4133 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4134 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4135 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4136 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4137 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4138 Instruction *NewOp =
4139 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4140 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4141 Op0I->getName()), I);
4142 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4143 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4144 }
4145
4146 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4147 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4148 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4149 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4150 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4151 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4152 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4153 }
4154 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4155 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4156 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4157 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4158 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4159 }
4160
4161 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4162 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4163 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4164 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4165 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4166 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4167 if (A == C)
4168 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4169 else if (A == D)
4170 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4171 else if (B == C)
4172 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4173 else if (B == D)
4174 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4175
4176 if (X) {
4177 Instruction *NewOp =
4178 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4179 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4180 }
4181 }
4182 }
4183
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004184 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4185 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4186 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattner3ac7c262003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004187 return R;
4188
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004189 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004190 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004191 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004192 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4193 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004194 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004195 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004196 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4197 I.getType(), TD) &&
4198 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4199 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer799b5bf2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004200 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4201 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4202 I.getName());
4203 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4204 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4205 }
Chris Lattner3af10532006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004206 }
Chris Lattnerf05d69a2006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004207
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004208 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004209}
4210
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004211/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4212/// overflowed for this type.
4213static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004214 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004215 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getAdd(In1, In2));
4216
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004217 if (IsSigned)
4218 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4219 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4220 else
4221 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4222 else
4223 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004224}
4225
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004226/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4227/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4228/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4229static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4230 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4231 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004232 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4233 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004234
4235 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner77defba2006-02-07 07:00:41 +00004236 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-TD.getPointerSize()*8);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004237
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004238 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4239 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattnerd35d2102005-01-13 23:26:48 +00004240 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004241 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004242 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
4243 if (!OpC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004244 OpC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004245 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4246 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4247 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4248 else {
4249 // Emit an add instruction.
4250 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4251 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4252 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4253 }
4254 }
4255 } else {
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00004256 // Convert to correct type.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004257 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::createSExtOrBitCast(Op, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner7aa41cf2005-01-14 17:17:59 +00004258 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4259 if (Size != 1)
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00004260 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4261 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4262 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004263
4264 // Emit an add instruction.
Chris Lattner4cb9fa32005-01-13 20:40:58 +00004265 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004266 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4267 }
4268 }
4269 return Result;
4270}
4271
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004272/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004273/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004274Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4275 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4276 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004277 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004278
4279 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4280 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4281 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4282
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004283 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4284 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4285 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004286 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4287 // each index is zero or not.
4288 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004289 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004290 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4291 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004292 bool EmitIt = true;
4293 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4294 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4295 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4296 if (C->isNullValue())
4297 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004298 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
4299 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004300 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004301 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004302 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4303 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004304 }
4305
4306 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004307 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004308 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004309 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4310 if (InVal == 0)
4311 InVal = Comp;
4312 else {
4313 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4314 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004315 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004316 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4317 else // True if all are equal
4318 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4319 }
4320 }
4321 }
4322
4323 if (InVal)
4324 return InVal;
4325 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004326 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004327 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4328 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004329 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004330
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004331 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004332 // the result to fold to a constant!
4333 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4334 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4335 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004336 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4337 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004338 }
4339 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004340 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4341 // compare the base pointer.
4342 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4343 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004344 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattnerbd43b9d2005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004345 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004346 if (IndicesTheSame)
4347 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4348 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4349 IndicesTheSame = false;
4350 break;
4351 }
4352
4353 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4354 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004355 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4356 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004357
4358 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4359 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004360 return 0;
Chris Lattnera21bf8d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004361 }
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004362
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004363 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4364 bool AllZeros = true;
4365 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4366 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4367 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4368 AllZeros = false;
4369 break;
4370 }
4371 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004372 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4373 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004374
4375 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004376 AllZeros = true;
4377 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4378 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4379 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4380 AllZeros = false;
4381 break;
4382 }
4383 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004384 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattner81e84172005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004385
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004386 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4387 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4388 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4389 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4390 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4391 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004392 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4393 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004394 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004395 NumDifferences = 2;
4396 break;
4397 } else {
4398 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4399 DiffOperand = i;
4400 }
4401 }
4402
4403 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4404 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004405 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4406 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004407 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattnerfc4429e2005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004408 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4409 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004410 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4411 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4fa89822005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004412 }
4413 }
4414
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004415 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004416 // the result to fold to a constant!
4417 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4418 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4419 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4420 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4421 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004422 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004423 }
4424 }
4425 return 0;
4426}
4427
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004428Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4429 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004430 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004431
Chris Lattner6ee923f2007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004432 // Fold trivial predicates.
4433 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4434 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4435 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4436 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4437
4438 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4439 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4440 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4441 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4442 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4443 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4444 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4445 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4446 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4447 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4448 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4449 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4450
4451 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4452 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4453 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4454 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4455 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4456 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4457 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4458 return &I;
4459
4460 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4461 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4462 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4463 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4464 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4465 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4466 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4467 return &I;
4468 }
4469 }
4470
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004471 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004472 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004473
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004474 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4475 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4476 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4477 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4478 case Instruction::PHI:
4479 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4480 return NV;
4481 break;
4482 case Instruction::Select:
4483 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4484 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4485 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4486 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4487 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4488 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4489 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4490 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4491 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4492 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4493 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4494 I.getName()), I);
4495 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4496 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4497 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4498 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4499 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4500 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4501 I.getName()), I);
4502 }
4503 }
4504
4505 if (Op1)
4506 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4507 break;
4508 }
4509 }
4510
4511 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4512}
4513
4514Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4515 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4516 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4517 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4518
4519 // icmp X, X
4520 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004521 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4522 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004523
4524 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004525 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004526
4527 // icmp of GlobalValues can never equal each other as long as they aren't
4528 // external weak linkage type.
4529 if (GlobalValue *GV0 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op0))
4530 if (GlobalValue *GV1 = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Op1))
4531 if (!GV0->hasExternalWeakLinkage() || !GV1->hasExternalWeakLinkage())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004532 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4533 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004534
4535 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004536 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004537 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4538 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4539 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner15ff1e12004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004540 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004541 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4542 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004543
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004544 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004545 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004546 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4547 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004549 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004550 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004551 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004552 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004553 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004554 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004555
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004556 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4558 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004559 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004562 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4563 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4564 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4565 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004566 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4567 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4568 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004569 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004570 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4571 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner4456da62004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004572 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4573 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4574 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4575 }
4576 }
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004577 }
4578
Chris Lattner2dd01742004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004579 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4580 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner6d14f2a2002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004581 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004582 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4583 default: break;
4584 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4585 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004587 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4588 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4589 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4590 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4591 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004592
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004593 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4594 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004595 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004596 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4597 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4598 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4599 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4600 break;
4601
4602 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4603 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004604 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004605 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4606 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4607 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4608 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4609 break;
4610
4611 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4612 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004613 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004614 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4615 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4616 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4617 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4618 break;
4619
4620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4621 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004622 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004623 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4624 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4625 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4626 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4627 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004628
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004629 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4630 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004632 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4633 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4634 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4635 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4636 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004637
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004638 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4639 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004640 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004641 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4642 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4643 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4644 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4645 break;
4646
4647 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4648 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004650 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4651 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4652 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4653 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4654 break;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004655 }
4656
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004657 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4658 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004659 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4660 //
Reid Spencer624766f2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004661 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4662 default: break;
4663 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4664 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4666 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4667 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4668 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4669 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4670 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4671 }
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004672
4673 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
4674 // in the input.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004675 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4676 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4677 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004678 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4679 return &I;
4680
4681 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4682 // in.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004683 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004684 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4685 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004686 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0), RHSVal(CI->getValue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004687 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004688 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4689 Max);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004690 } else {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004691 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4692 Max);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004693 }
4694 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4695 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4696 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004697 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004698 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004699 break;
4700 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004701 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004702 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004703 break;
4704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004705 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004706 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004707 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004708 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004709 break;
4710 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004711 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004713 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004714 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004715 break;
4716 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004717 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004718 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004719 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004720 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004721 break;
4722 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004723 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004725 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004726 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004727 break;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004728 }
4729 }
4730
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004731 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004732 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004733 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattnere1e10e12004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004734 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004735 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4736 case Instruction::And:
4737 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
4738 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004739 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
4740
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004741 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004742 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
4743 // produced, eliminating a cast.
4744 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
4745 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
4746 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
4747 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
4748 // bit would not work.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004749 if (Cast->hasOneUse() && isa<TruncInst>(Cast) &&
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004750 (I.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
4751 CI->getValue().isPositive())) {
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004752 ConstantInt *NewCST;
4753 ConstantInt *NewCI;
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004754 APInt NewCSTVal(AndCST->getValue()), NewCIVal(CI->getValue());
4755 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(
4756 Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
4757 NewCST = ConstantInt::get(NewCSTVal.zext(BitWidth));
4758 NewCI = ConstantInt::get(NewCIVal.zext(BitWidth));
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004759 Instruction *NewAnd =
4760 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0), NewCST,
4761 LHSI->getName());
4762 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004763 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NewAnd, NewCI);
Chris Lattner4922a0e2006-09-18 05:27:43 +00004764 }
4765 }
4766
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004767 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
4768 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
4769 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
4770 // access.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004771 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
4772 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
4773 Shift = 0;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004774
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004775 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
4776 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004777 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
4778 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004779
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004780 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
4781 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
4782 // rights, as they sign-extend.
4783 if (ShAmt) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004784 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004785 if (!CanFold) {
4786 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
4787 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004788 int ShAmtVal = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-ShAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc53cb9d2005-06-17 01:29:28 +00004789 if (ShAmtVal < 0) ShAmtVal = 0; // Out of range shift.
4790
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004791 Constant *OShAmt = ConstantInt::get(AndTy, ShAmtVal);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004792 Constant *ShVal =
Chris Lattneree0f2802006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004793 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(AndTy),
4794 OShAmt);
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004795 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(ShVal, AndCST)->isNullValue())
4796 CanFold = true;
4797 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004798
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004799 if (CanFold) {
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004800 Constant *NewCst;
4801 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004802 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004803 else
4804 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt);
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00004805
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004806 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
4807 // compared.
4808 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != CI){
4809 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
4810 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
4811 // result is always true or false now.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004812 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004813 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004814 if (I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004816 } else {
4817 I.setOperand(1, NewCst);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004818 Constant *NewAndCST;
4819 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004820 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner6afc02f2004-09-28 17:54:07 +00004821 else
4822 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
4823 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
Reid Spencer6ff3e732007-01-04 05:23:51 +00004824 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004825 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004826 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
4827 return &I;
Chris Lattner1638de42004-07-21 19:50:44 +00004828 }
4829 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00004830 }
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004831
4832 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
4833 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
4834 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
4835 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && CI->isNullValue() &&
Chris Lattnerde077922006-09-18 18:27:05 +00004836 I.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
4837 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004838 // Compute C << Y.
4839 Value *NS;
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004840 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00004841 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004842 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004843 } else {
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00004844 // Insert a logical shift.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00004845 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004846 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004847 }
4848 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), I);
4849
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004850 // Compute X & (C << Y).
Reid Spencer6ff3e732007-01-04 05:23:51 +00004851 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(
4852 Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004853 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, I);
4854
4855 I.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
4856 return &I;
4857 }
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00004858 }
4859 break;
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00004860
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004861 case Instruction::Shl: // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004862 if (ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004863 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004864 unsigned TypeBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
4865
4866 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
4867 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
4868 // simplified.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004869 if (ShAmt->getZExtValue() >= TypeBits)
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004870 break;
4871
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004872 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
4873 // comparison cannot succeed.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004874 Constant *Comp =
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004875 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt), ShAmt);
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004876 if (Comp != CI) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004877 bool IsICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004878 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Cst);
4880 }
4881
4882 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4883 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004884 unsigned ShAmtVal = (unsigned)ShAmt->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00004885 uint64_t Val = (1ULL << (TypeBits-ShAmtVal))-1;
4886 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), Val);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004887
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004888 Instruction *AndI =
4889 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
4890 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
4891 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004892 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And,
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004893 ConstantExpr::getLShr(CI, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004894 }
4895 }
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004896 }
4897 break;
4898
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004899 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004900 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004901 if (ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00004902 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004903 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
4904 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
4905 // simplified.
Chris Lattner104002b2005-06-16 01:52:07 +00004906 unsigned TypeBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004907 if (ShAmt->getZExtValue() >= TypeBits)
Chris Lattner19b57f52005-06-15 20:53:31 +00004908 break;
4909
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004910 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
4911 // comparison cannot succeed.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004912 Constant *Comp;
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00004913 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00004914 Comp = ConstantExpr::getLShr(ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt),
4915 ShAmt);
4916 else
4917 Comp = ConstantExpr::getAShr(ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt),
4918 ShAmt);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004919
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004920 if (Comp != CI) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004921 bool IsICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004922 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004923 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Cst);
4924 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004925
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004926 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || CI->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00004927 unsigned ShAmtVal = (unsigned)ShAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner272d5ca2004-09-28 18:22:15 +00004928
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004929 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004930 APInt Val(APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits).shl(ShAmtVal));
4931 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004932
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004933 Instruction *AndI =
4934 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
4935 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
4936 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004937 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And,
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004938 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShAmt));
4939 }
Chris Lattner1023b872004-09-27 16:18:50 +00004940 }
4941 }
4942 break;
Chris Lattner7e794272004-09-24 15:21:34 +00004943
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004944 case Instruction::SDiv:
4945 case Instruction::UDiv:
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004946 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004947 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
4948 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
4949 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
4950 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
4951 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004952 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004953 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
4954 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
4955 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
4956 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
4957 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
4958 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
4959 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
4960 // if it finds it.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004961 bool DivIsSigned = LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
4962 if (!I.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != I.isSignedPredicate())
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004963 break;
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004964 if (DivRHS->isZero())
4965 break; // Don't hack on div by zero
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004966
4967 // Initialize the variables that will indicate the nature of the
4968 // range check.
4969 bool LoOverflow = false, HiOverflow = false;
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004970 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
4971
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004972 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
4973 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
4974 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
4975 // instead of computing a divide.
4976 ConstantInt *Prod =
4977 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getMul(CI, DivRHS));
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004978
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004979 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
4980 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
4981 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004982 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
4983 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CI;
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004984
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004985 // Get the ICmp opcode
4986 ICmpInst::Predicate predicate = I.getPredicate();
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00004987
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004988 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004989 LoBound = Prod;
4990 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004991 HiOverflow = ProdOV ||
4992 AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00004993 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004994 if (CI->isNullValue()) { // (X / pos) op 0
4995 // Can't overflow.
4996 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
4997 HiBound = DivRHS;
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00004998 } else if (CI->getValue().isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004999 LoBound = Prod;
5000 LoOverflow = ProdOV;
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005001 HiOverflow = ProdOV ||
5002 AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005003 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
5004 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5005 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005006 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true);
5007 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005008 HiOverflow = ProdOV;
5009 }
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005010 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005011 if (CI->isNullValue()) { // (X / neg) op 0
5012 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5013 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner73bcba52005-06-17 02:05:55 +00005014 if (HiBound == DivRHS)
Reid Spencer7e80b0b2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005015 LoBound = 0; // - INTMIN = INTMIN
Reid Spencer450434e2007-03-19 20:58:18 +00005016 } else if (CI->getValue().isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005017 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5018 if (!LoOverflow)
Reid Spencerf4071162007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005019 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS),
5020 true);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005021 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5022 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
5023 LoBound = Prod;
5024 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
5025 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getSub(Prod, DivRHS));
5026 }
Chris Lattner0b41e862004-10-08 19:15:44 +00005027
Chris Lattnera92af962004-10-11 19:40:04 +00005028 // Dividing by a negate swaps the condition.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005029 predicate = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(predicate);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005030 }
5031
5032 if (LoBound) {
5033 Value *X = LHSI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005034 switch (predicate) {
5035 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5036 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005037 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005038 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005039 else if (HiOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005040 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5041 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005042 else if (LoOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005043 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5044 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005045 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005046 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned,
5047 true, I);
5048 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005049 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005050 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005051 else if (HiOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005052 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5053 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005054 else if (LoOverflow)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005055 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5056 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005057 else
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005058 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned,
5059 false, I);
5060 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5061 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005062 if (LoOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005063 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005064 return new ICmpInst(predicate, X, LoBound);
5065 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5066 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005067 if (HiOverflow)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005068 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005069 if (predicate == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
5070 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5071 else
5072 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005073 }
5074 }
5075 }
5076 break;
Chris Lattnere1b4d2a2004-09-23 21:52:49 +00005077 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005078
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005079 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005080 if (I.isEquality()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005081 bool isICMP_NE = I.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00005082
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005083 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5084 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005085 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5086 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005087 case Instruction::SRem:
5088 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005089 if (CI->isZero() && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005090 BO->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005091 APInt V(cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue());
5092 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer7eb55b32006-11-02 01:53:59 +00005093 Value *NewRem = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createURem(
5094 BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1), BO->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005095 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5096 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner23b47b62004-07-06 07:38:18 +00005097 }
Chris Lattner22d00a82005-08-02 19:16:58 +00005098 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005099 break;
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005100 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner6e079362004-06-27 22:51:36 +00005101 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5102 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerb121ae12004-09-21 21:35:23 +00005103 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005104 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5105 ConstantExpr::getSub(CI, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner6e079362004-06-27 22:51:36 +00005106 } else if (CI->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005107 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5108 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5109 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005110
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005111 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005112 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005113 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005114 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattnerf95d9b92003-10-15 16:48:29 +00005115 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005116 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005117 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005118 Neg->takeName(BO);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005119 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005120 }
5121 }
5122 break;
5123 case Instruction::Xor:
5124 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5125 // the explicit xor.
5126 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005127 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5128 ConstantExpr::getXor(CI, BOC));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005129
5130 // FALLTHROUGH
5131 case Instruction::Sub:
5132 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005133 if (CI->isZero())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005134 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5135 BO->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005136 break;
5137
5138 case Instruction::Or:
5139 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5140 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005141 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00005142 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(CI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00005143 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5145 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnerc1e7cc02004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005146 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005147 break;
5148
5149 case Instruction::And:
5150 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00005151 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5152 // comparison can never succeed!
Chris Lattnerc8e7e292004-06-10 02:12:35 +00005153 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(CI,
5154 ConstantExpr::getNot(BOC))->isNullValue())
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005155 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5156 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005157
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00005158 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
Chris Lattneree59d4b2004-06-10 02:33:20 +00005159 if (CI == BOC && isOneBitSet(CI))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005160 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5161 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,
5162 Constant::getNullValue(CI->getType()));
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00005163
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005164 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005165 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5166 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005167 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5168 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5169 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5170 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005171 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005172
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00005173 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00005174 if (CI->isNullValue() && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5175 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerbfff18a2004-09-27 19:29:18 +00005176 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005177 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5178 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5179 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner8fc5af42004-09-23 21:46:38 +00005180 }
5181
Chris Lattnerd492a0b2003-07-23 17:02:11 +00005182 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005183 default: break;
5184 }
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005185 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Op0)) {
5186 // Handle set{eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5187 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
5188 default: break;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005189 case Intrinsic::bswap_i16:
5190 // icmp eq (bswap(x)), c -> icmp eq (x,bswap(c))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00005191 AddToWorkList(II); // Dead?
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005192 I.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005193 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int16Ty,
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005194 ByteSwap_16(CI->getZExtValue())));
5195 return &I;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005196 case Intrinsic::bswap_i32:
5197 // icmp eq (bswap(x)), c -> icmp eq (x,bswap(c))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00005198 AddToWorkList(II); // Dead?
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005199 I.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005200 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005201 ByteSwap_32(CI->getZExtValue())));
5202 return &I;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005203 case Intrinsic::bswap_i64:
5204 // icmp eq (bswap(x)), c -> icmp eq (x,bswap(c))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00005205 AddToWorkList(II); // Dead?
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005206 I.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005207 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int64Ty,
Chris Lattnera7942b72006-11-29 05:02:16 +00005208 ByteSwap_64(CI->getZExtValue())));
5209 return &I;
5210 }
Chris Lattnerc992add2003-08-13 05:33:12 +00005211 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005212 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
5213 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size, then
5214 // since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005215 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5216 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5217 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005218 unsigned SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005219 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005220 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005221 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5222 // smaller constant values.
5223 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5224 default: break;
5225 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: { // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5226 ConstantInt *CUI = cast<ConstantInt>(CI);
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005227 if (CUI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(SrcTySize))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005228 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005229 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005230 break;
5231 }
5232 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: { // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5233 ConstantInt *CUI = cast<ConstantInt>(CI);
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005234 if (CUI->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005235 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5236 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5237 break;
5238 }
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005239 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005240
Chris Lattner2b55ea32004-02-23 07:16:20 +00005241 }
5242 }
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00005243 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005244 }
5245
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005246 // Handle icmp with constant RHS
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005247 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5248 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5249 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005250 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5251 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005252 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005253 bool isAllZeros = true;
5254 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5255 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5256 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5257 isAllZeros = false;
5258 break;
5259 }
5260 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005261 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera816eee2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005262 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5263 }
5264 break;
5265
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005266 case Instruction::PHI:
5267 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5268 return NV;
5269 break;
5270 case Instruction::Select:
5271 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5272 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5273 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5274 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5275 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5276 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5277 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005278 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5279 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5280 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5281 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5282 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005283 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5284 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005285 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5286 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5287 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5288 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5289 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005290 }
5291 }
Jeff Cohen82639852005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005292
Chris Lattner77c32c32005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005293 if (Op1)
5294 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
5295 break;
5296 }
5297 }
5298
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005299 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005300 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005301 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005302 return NI;
5303 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005304 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5305 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005306 return NI;
5307
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005308 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005309 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5310 // now.
5311 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5312 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5313 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005314 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5315 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005316 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005317
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005318 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5319 // so eliminate it as well.
5320 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5321 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005322
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005323 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005324 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005325 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005326 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005327 } else {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005328 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005329 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005330 }
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005331 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner16930792003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005332 }
Chris Lattner64d87b02007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005333 }
5334
5335 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005336 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005337 // This comes up when you have code like
5338 // int X = A < B;
5339 // if (X) ...
5340 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005341 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5342 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005343 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005344 return R;
Chris Lattner6444c372003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005345 }
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005346
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005347 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005348 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5349 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5350 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5351 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5352 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5353 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5354 }
5355
5356 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5357 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5358 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5359 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5360 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
5361 Constant *NC = ConstantExpr::getXor(C1, C2);
5362 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5363 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5364 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5365 }
5366
5367 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5368 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5369 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5370 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5371 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5372 }
5373 }
5374
5375 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5376 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005377 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5378 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005379 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5380 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005381 }
5382 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005383 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005384 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5385 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner17c7c032007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005386 }
5387 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005388 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005389 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5390 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005391 }
Chris Lattnerd12a4bf2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005392
Chris Lattnerd12a4bf2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005393 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5394 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5395 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5396 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5397 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5398
5399 if (A == C) {
5400 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5401 } else if (A == D) {
5402 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5403 } else if (B == C) {
5404 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5405 } else if (B == D) {
5406 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5407 }
5408
5409 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5410 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5411 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5412 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5413 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5414 return &I;
5415 }
5416 }
Chris Lattnerf5c8a0b2006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005417 }
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005418 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005419}
5420
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005421// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005422// We only handle extending casts so far.
5423//
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005424Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5425 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005426 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5427 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005428 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005429 Value *RHSCIOp;
5430
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005431 // We only handle extension cast instructions, so far. Enforce this.
5432 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5433 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattner03f06f12005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005434 return 0;
5435
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005436 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5437 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005438
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005439 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005440 // Not an extension from the same type?
5441 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005442 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5443 return 0;
Chris Lattner387bf3f2007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005444
5445 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5446 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5447 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5448 return 0;
5449
5450 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5451 // then we can't handle this.
5452 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5453 return 0;
5454
5455 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5456 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer279fa252004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005457 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005458
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005459 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5460 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5461 if (!CI)
5462 return 0;
5463
5464 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5465 // reextended to DestTy.
5466 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5467 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5468
5469 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5470 if (Res2 == CI) {
5471 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5472 // For example, we might have:
5473 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5474 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5475 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5476 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5477 // because %A may have negative value.
5478 //
5479 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5480 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005481 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005482 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5483 else
5484 return 0;
5485 }
5486
5487 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5488 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5489
5490 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5491 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5492 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005493 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005494 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005496
5497 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5498 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5499 Value *Result;
5500 if (isSignedCmp) {
5501 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005502 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005503 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005504 else
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005505 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005506 } else {
5507 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5508 if (isSignedExt) {
5509 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5510 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005511 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005512 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5513 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5514 } else {
5515 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005516 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005517 }
5518 }
5519
5520 // Finally, return the value computed.
5521 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5522 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5523 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5524 } else {
5525 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5526 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5527 "ICmp should be folded!");
5528 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5529 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5530 else
5531 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5532 }
Chris Lattnerd1f46d32005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005533}
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005534
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005535Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5536 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5537}
5538
5539Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5540 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5541}
5542
5543Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5544 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5545}
5546
5547Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5548 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005549 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005550
5551 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5552 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005553 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattnere6794492002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005554 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5555 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005556
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005557 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5558 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner67f05452004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005559 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005560 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005561 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5562 }
5563 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005564 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5565 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5566 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005567 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005568 }
5569
Chris Lattnerd4dee402006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005570 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5571 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005572 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerd4dee402006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005573 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005574 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5575
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005576 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5577 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5578 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005579 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005580 return R;
5581
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005582 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005583 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005584 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5585 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005586 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattnerb18dbbf2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005587 }
5588 }
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005589
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005590 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005591 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5592 return Res;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005593 return 0;
5594}
5595
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005596Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005597 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005598 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005599
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005600 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5601 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005602 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5603 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5604 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattnerf5b4ef72006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005605 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5606 return &I;
5607
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005608 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5609 // of a signed value.
5610 //
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005611 if (Op1->getZExtValue() >= TypeBits) { // shift amount always <= 32 bits
Chris Lattnerd5fea612007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005612 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005613 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5614 else {
Chris Lattnerd5fea612007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005615 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005616 return &I;
Chris Lattnerf5ce2542004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005617 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005618 }
5619
5620 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5621 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5622 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5623 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5624 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5625 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5626
5627 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5628 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5629 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5630 return R;
5631 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5632 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5633 return NV;
5634
5635 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005636 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5637 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5638 Value *V1, *V2;
5639 ConstantInt *CC;
5640 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005641 default: break;
5642 case Instruction::Add:
5643 case Instruction::And:
5644 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005645 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005646 // These operators commute.
5647 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005648 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5649 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005650 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005651 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005652 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005653 Op0BO->getName());
5654 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005655 Instruction *X =
5656 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5657 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005658 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
5659 Constant *C2 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005660 C2 = ConstantExpr::getShl(C2, Op1);
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005661 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, C2);
5662 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005663
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005664 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005665 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerfe53cf22007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005666 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005667 match(Op0BOOp1,
5668 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattnerfe53cf22007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005669 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5670 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005671 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005672 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5673 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005674 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5675 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005676 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005677 V1->getName()+".mask");
5678 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5679
5680 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
5681 }
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005682 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005683
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005684 // FALL THROUGH.
5685 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005686 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005687 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5688 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005689 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005690 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005691 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5692 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005693 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005694 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005695 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005696 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005697 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
5698 Constant *C2 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005699 C2 = ConstantExpr::getShl(C2, Op1);
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005700 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, C2);
5701 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005702
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005703 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005704 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5705 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
5706 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005707 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner24cd2fa2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005708 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
5709 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005710 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005711 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5712 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005713 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5714 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005715 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005716 V1->getName()+".mask");
5717 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5718
Chris Lattner1df0e982006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005719 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner797dee72005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005720 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005721
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005722 break;
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005723 }
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005724 }
5725
5726
5727 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
5728 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
5729 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
5730 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
5731 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
5732
5733 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005734 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner44bd3922004-10-08 03:46:20 +00005735 case Instruction::Add:
5736 isValid = isLeftShift;
5737 break;
Chris Lattnerdeaa0dd2003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005738 case Instruction::Or:
5739 case Instruction::Xor:
5740 highBitSet = false;
5741 break;
5742 case Instruction::And:
5743 highBitSet = true;
5744 break;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005745 }
5746
5747 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
5748 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
5749 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
5750 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
5751 // operation.
5752 //
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005753 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00005754 isValid = ((Op0C->getValue() & APInt::getSignBit(TypeBits)) != 0) ==
5755 highBitSet;
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005756 }
5757
5758 if (isValid) {
5759 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
5760
5761 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005762 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005763 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00005764 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner14553932006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005765
5766 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
5767 NewRHS);
5768 }
5769 }
5770 }
5771 }
5772
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005773 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005774 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5775 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
5776 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005777
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005778 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005779 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00005780 // These shift amounts are always <= 32 bits.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005781 unsigned ShiftAmt1 = (unsigned)ShiftAmt1C->getZExtValue();
5782 unsigned ShiftAmt2 = (unsigned)Op1->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005783 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
5784 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
5785 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005786
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005787 unsigned AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005788 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
5789 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005790
5791 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
5792
5793 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner6c344e52007-02-03 23:28:07 +00005794 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005795 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
5796 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5797 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
5798 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
5799 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
5800 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5801 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
5802 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5803 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
5804 Instruction *Shift =
5805 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
5806 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5807
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00005808 APInt Mask(Ty->getMask().lshr(ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005809 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005810 }
5811
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005812 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
5813 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
5814 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
5815 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
5816 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005817 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005818 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005819 }
5820 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
5821 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Shenge9ebd3f2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00005822 APInt Mask(Ty->getMask().lshr(ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005823 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005824 }
5825 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
5826 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
5827 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
5828 // generators.
5829 const Type *SExtType = 0;
5830 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005831 case 1 : SExtType = Type::Int1Ty; break;
5832 case 8 : SExtType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
5833 case 16 : SExtType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
5834 case 32 : SExtType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
5835 case 64 : SExtType = Type::Int64Ty; break;
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005836 default: break;
5837 }
5838 if (SExtType) {
5839 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
5840 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
5841 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
5842 }
5843 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
5844 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
5845 unsigned ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005846
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005847 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005848 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5849 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
5850 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattner9cbfbc22006-01-07 01:32:28 +00005851 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005852 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattner9cbfbc22006-01-07 01:32:28 +00005853 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5854
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005855 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
5856 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005857 }
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005858
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005859 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005860 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5861 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
5862 Instruction *Shift =
5863 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5864 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005865
Reid Spencer769a5a82007-03-26 17:18:58 +00005866 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005867 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner27cb9db2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005868 }
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005869
5870 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
5871 } else {
5872 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
5873 unsigned ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
5874
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005875 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005876 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5877 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
5878 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
5879 Instruction *Shift =
5880 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
5881 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5882 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5883
Reid Spencer52830322007-03-25 21:11:44 +00005884 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005885 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005886 }
5887
Chris Lattner83ac5ae92007-02-05 05:57:49 +00005888 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005889 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5890 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
5891 Instruction *Shift =
5892 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
5893 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
5894
Reid Spencer441486c2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00005895 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencer6274c722007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005896 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner3e009e82007-02-05 00:57:54 +00005897 }
5898
5899 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005900 }
Chris Lattnereb372a02006-01-06 07:52:12 +00005901 }
Chris Lattnerf4cdbf32002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005902 return 0;
5903}
5904
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00005905
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005906/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
5907/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
5908/// X*Scale+Offset.
5909///
5910static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
5911 unsigned &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005912 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005913 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005914 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
5915 Scale = 1;
5916 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005917 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val)) {
5918 if (I->getNumOperands() == 2) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005919 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005920 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
5921 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
5922 Scale = 1U << CUI->getZExtValue();
5923 Offset = 0;
5924 return I->getOperand(0);
5925 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
5926 // This value is scaled by 'CUI'.
5927 Scale = CUI->getZExtValue();
5928 Offset = 0;
5929 return I->getOperand(0);
5930 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
5931 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
5932 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
5933 unsigned SubScale;
5934 Value *SubVal =
5935 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
5936 Offset += CUI->getZExtValue();
5937 if (SubScale > 1 && (Offset % SubScale == 0)) {
5938 Scale = SubScale;
5939 return SubVal;
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005940 }
5941 }
5942 }
5943 }
5944 }
5945
5946 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
5947 Scale = 1;
5948 Offset = 0;
5949 return Val;
5950}
5951
5952
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005953/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
5954/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
5955Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(CastInst &CI,
5956 AllocationInst &AI) {
5957 const PointerType *PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00005958 if (!PTy) return 0; // Not casting the allocation to a pointer type.
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005959
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005960 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
5961 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner99c6cf62007-02-15 22:52:10 +00005962
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005963 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
5964 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
5965 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
5966 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
5967 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
5968
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005969 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00005970 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattner51f54572007-03-02 19:59:19 +00005971 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerac87beb2005-10-24 06:22:12 +00005972 }
5973 }
5974
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005975 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
5976 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
5977 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
5978 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005979
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00005980 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
5981 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005982 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
5983
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00005984 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
5985 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
5986 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
5987 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
5988
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00005989 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
5990 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00005991 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner355ecc02005-10-24 06:26:18 +00005992
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005993 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
5994 // size argument.
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00005995 unsigned ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset;
5996 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
5997 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
5998
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00005999 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6000 // do the xform.
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006001 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6002 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattnerb3ecf962005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006003
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006004 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6005 Value *Amt = 0;
6006 if (Scale == 1) {
6007 Amt = NumElements;
6008 } else {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006009 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006010 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6011 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006012 Amt = ConstantExpr::getMul(
6013 cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
6014 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner8270c332005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006015 else if (Scale != 1) {
6016 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
6017 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattnerb3ecf962005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006018 }
Chris Lattnerbb171802005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006019 }
6020
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006021 if (unsigned Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006022 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset);
Chris Lattner8f663e82005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006023 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
6024 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6025 }
6026
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006027 AllocationInst *New;
6028 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006029 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006030 else
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006031 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006032 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006033 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006034
6035 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6036 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6037 // die soon.
6038 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6039 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006040 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6041 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6042 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner46705b22005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006043 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6044 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6045 }
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006046 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6047}
6048
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006049/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006050/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6051/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6052/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6053/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6054///
6055/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6056/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6057static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006058 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006059 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6060 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6061 return true;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006062
6063 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006064 if (!I) return false;
6065
6066 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006067
6068 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006069 case Instruction::Add:
6070 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006071 case Instruction::And:
6072 case Instruction::Or:
6073 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006074 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006075 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
6076 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved) &&
6077 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006078
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006079 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006080 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6081 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6082 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6083 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6084 if (Ty->getBitWidth() < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6085 CI->getZExtValue() < Ty->getBitWidth())
6086 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty,NumCastsRemoved);
6087 }
6088 break;
6089 case Instruction::LShr:
6090 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6091 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6092 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6093 // already zeros.
6094 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006095 uint32_t BitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng755f04b2007-03-23 02:39:25 +00006096 if (Ty->getBitWidth() < BitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006097 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc3e3b8a2007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006098 APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth) &
6099 APInt::getAllOnesValue(Ty->getBitWidth()).zextOrTrunc(BitWidth).flip())
6100 && CI->getZExtValue() < Ty->getBitWidth()) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006101 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, NumCastsRemoved);
6102 }
6103 }
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006104 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006105 case Instruction::Trunc:
6106 case Instruction::ZExt:
6107 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006108 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6109 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6110 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
Chris Lattner3fda3862006-06-28 17:34:50 +00006111 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6112 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6113 // casts first.
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00006114 if (isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner3fda3862006-06-28 17:34:50 +00006115 return true;
6116
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006117 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6118 return true;
6119 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006120 break;
6121 default:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006122 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6123 break;
6124 }
6125
6126 return false;
6127}
6128
6129/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6130/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6131/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006132Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006133 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006134 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006135 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006136
6137 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6138 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerd0622b62006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006139 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006140 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006141 case Instruction::Add:
6142 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006143 case Instruction::And:
6144 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006145 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006146 case Instruction::AShr:
6147 case Instruction::LShr:
6148 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006149 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006150 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6151 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6152 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner960acb02006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006153 break;
6154 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006155 case Instruction::Trunc:
6156 case Instruction::ZExt:
6157 case Instruction::SExt:
6158 case Instruction::BitCast:
6159 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
6160 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because its not new.
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006161 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6162 return I->getOperand(0);
6163
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006164 // Some other kind of cast, which shouldn't happen, so just ..
6165 // FALL THROUGH
6166 default:
Chris Lattner1ebbe6a2006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006167 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6168 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6169 break;
6170 }
6171
6172 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6173}
6174
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006175/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6176Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006177 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6178
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006179 // Casting undef to anything results in undef so might as just replace it and
6180 // get rid of the cast.
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006181 if (isa<UndefValue>(Src)) // cast undef -> undef
6182 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(CI.getType()));
6183
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006184 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If its eliminable we just
6185 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006186 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006187 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6188 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6189 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6190 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6191 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner650b6da2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006192 }
6193 }
Chris Lattner03841652004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006194
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006195 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6196 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
6197 //
Chris Lattner55d4bda2003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006198 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006199 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
6200 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6201 if (!isa<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i)) ||
6202 !cast<Constant>(GEP->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6203 AllZeroOperands = false;
6204 break;
6205 }
6206 if (AllZeroOperands) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006207 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6208 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6209 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattnerd0d51602003-06-21 23:12:02 +00006210 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6211 return &CI;
6212 }
6213 }
Chris Lattnerec45a4c2006-11-21 17:05:13 +00006214
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006215 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
6216 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006217 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
Chris Lattner216be912005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006218 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
6219 return V;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00006220
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006221 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner86102b82005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006222 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6223 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6224 return NV;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006225
6226 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006227 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6228 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6229 return NV;
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006230
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006231 return 0;
6232}
6233
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006234/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6235/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006236/// cases.
6237/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6238Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6239 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6240 return Result;
6241
6242 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6243 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6244 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
6245 unsigned SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6246 unsigned DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6247
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006248 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6249 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006250 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6251 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006252 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6253 return &CI;
6254
6255 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6256 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006257 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6258 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006259 return 0;
6260
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006261 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006262 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006263 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6264 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
6265 NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006266 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
6267 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a noop-cast
6268 // this just removes a noop cast which isn't pointful, but simplifies
6269 // the code. If this is a zero-extension, we need to do an AND to
6270 // maintain the clear top-part of the computation, so we require that
6271 // the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this is a sign
6272 // extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
6273 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerda1d04a2007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006274 bool DoXForm;
6275 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6276 default:
6277 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6278 // get here because of the check above.
6279 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6280 case Instruction::Trunc:
6281 DoXForm = true;
6282 break;
6283 case Instruction::ZExt:
6284 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6285 break;
6286 case Instruction::SExt:
6287 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6288 break;
6289 case Instruction::BitCast:
6290 DoXForm = false;
6291 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006292 }
6293
6294 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006295 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6296 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006297 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6298 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6299 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6300 case Instruction::Trunc:
6301 case Instruction::BitCast:
6302 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6303 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6304 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6305 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6306 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006307 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcBitSize));
6308 C = ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, DestTy);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006309 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6310 }
6311 case Instruction::SExt:
6312 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6313 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006314 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6315 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006316 }
6317 }
6318 }
6319
6320 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6321 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6322
6323 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6324 case Instruction::Add:
6325 case Instruction::Mul:
6326 case Instruction::And:
6327 case Instruction::Or:
6328 case Instruction::Xor:
6329 // If we are discarding information, or just changing the sign,
6330 // rewrite.
6331 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6332 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6333 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6334 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6335 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006336 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6337 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer2a499b02006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006338 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006339 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6340 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6341 return BinaryOperator::create(
6342 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006343 }
6344 }
6345
6346 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6347 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6348 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006349 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006350 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006351 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006352 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6353 }
6354 break;
6355 case Instruction::SDiv:
6356 case Instruction::UDiv:
6357 case Instruction::SRem:
6358 case Instruction::URem:
6359 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6360 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6361 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6362 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6363 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006364 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6365 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006366 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6367 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6368 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6369 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006370 return BinaryOperator::create(
6371 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6372 }
6373 }
6374 break;
6375
6376 case Instruction::Shl:
6377 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6378 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6379 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6380 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6381 // in the value.
6382 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6383 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006384 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6385 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6386 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006387 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006388 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006389 }
6390 break;
6391 case Instruction::AShr:
6392 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6393 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6394 // simplifications.
6395 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6396 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6397 unsigned ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getZExtValue();
6398 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6399 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006400 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006401 }
6402 }
6403 break;
6404
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006405 case Instruction::ICmp:
6406 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and casting it
6407 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006408 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6409 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006410 APInt Op1CV(Op1C->getValue());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006411 // cast (X == 0) to int --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6412 // cast (X == 0) to int --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6413 // cast (X == 1) to int --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6414 // cast (X == 2) to int --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6415 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6416 // cast (X != 0) to int --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6417 // cast (X != 1) to int --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6418 // cast (X != 2) to int --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006419 if (Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006420 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006421 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
6422 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6423 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006424 ComputeMaskedBits(Op0, TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006425
6426 // This only works for EQ and NE
6427 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI)->getPredicate();
6428 if (pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6429 break;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006430
Zhou Sheng0900993e2007-03-23 03:13:21 +00006431 APInt KnownZeroMask(KnownZero ^ TypeMask);
6432 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006433 bool isNE = pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Zhou Sheng0900993e2007-03-23 03:13:21 +00006434 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006435 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6436 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006437 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006438 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006439 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6440 }
6441
Zhou Sheng0900993e2007-03-23 03:13:21 +00006442 unsigned ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006443 Value *In = Op0;
6444 if (ShiftAmt) {
6445 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6446 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6447 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006448 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006449 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6450 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006451 }
6452
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006453 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006454 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6455 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6456 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6457 }
6458
6459 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6460 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6461 else
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006462 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006463 }
6464 }
6465 }
6466 break;
6467 }
6468 return 0;
6469}
6470
6471Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006472 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6473 return Result;
6474
6475 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6476 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
6477 unsigned DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006478 unsigned SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006479
6480 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6481 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6482 default: break;
6483 case Instruction::LShr:
6484 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6485 // are already zeros.
6486 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
6487 unsigned ShAmt = ShAmtV->getZExtValue();
6488
6489 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006490 APInt Mask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcBitWidth).lshr(
6491 SrcBitWidth-ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006492 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6493 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006494 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6496
6497 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6498 // shift.
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006499 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6500 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6501 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006502 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006503 }
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006504 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6505
6506 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6507 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6508 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006509 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006510 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6511
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006512 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer0d5f9232007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006513 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006514 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006515 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6516 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6517 "tmp"), CI);
6518 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006519 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnerc209b582006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006520 }
Chris Lattnerd747f012006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006521 }
6522 break;
6523 }
6524 }
6525
6526 return 0;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006527}
6528
6529Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(CastInst &CI) {
6530 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6531 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6532 return Result;
6533
6534 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6535
6536 // If this is a cast of a cast
6537 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006538 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6539 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6540 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6541 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6542 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6543 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
6544 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6545 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6546 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6547 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6548 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6549 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Reid Spencer4154e732007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006550 APInt AndValue(APInt::getAllOnesValue(MidSize).zext(SrcSize));
6551 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006552 Instruction *And =
6553 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6554 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6555 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6556 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6557 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006558 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006559 }
6560 return And;
6561 }
6562 }
6563 }
6564
6565 return 0;
6566}
6567
6568Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(CastInst &CI) {
6569 return commonIntCastTransforms(CI);
6570}
6571
6572Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
6573 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6574}
6575
6576Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
6577 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6578}
6579
6580Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006581 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006582}
6583
6584Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006585 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006586}
6587
6588Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6589 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6590}
6591
6592Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6593 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6594}
6595
6596Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencerad05ee92006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006597 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006598}
6599
6600Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
6601 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6602}
6603
6604Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(CastInst &CI) {
6605
6606 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
6607 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
6608 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6609 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6610 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
6611
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00006612 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006613 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6614 return Result;
6615 } else {
6616 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6617 return Result;
6618 }
6619
6620
6621 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
6622 // be replaced by the operand.
6623 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
6624 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
6625
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006626 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent to
6627 // a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate getelementptr.
6628 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006629 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
6630 if (const PointerType *SrcPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
6631 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
6632 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006633
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006634 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006635 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006636 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
6637 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
6638 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
6639 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006640 ++NumZeros;
6641 }
Chris Lattner6a4adcd2004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006642
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006643 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006644 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
Chris Lattner416a8932007-01-31 20:08:52 +00006645 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
6646 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, &Idxs[0], Idxs.size());
Chris Lattnerb19a5c62006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006647 }
6648 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006649 }
Chris Lattnerdfae8be2003-07-24 17:35:25 +00006650
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006651 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
6652 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
6653 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
6654 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00006655 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
6656 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006657 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
6658 CastInst *Tmp;
6659 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
6660 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
6661 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
6662 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
6663 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
6664 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
6665 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006666 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6667 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
6668 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6669 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006670 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
6671 // know the vector types match #elts.
6672 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner99155be2006-05-25 23:24:33 +00006673 }
6674 }
6675 }
6676 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00006677 return 0;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00006678}
6679
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006680/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
6681/// %C = or %A, %B
6682/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
6683/// into:
6684/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
6685/// %D = or %A, %C
6686///
6687/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
6688/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
6689/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
6690///
6691static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
6692 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
6693 case Instruction::Add:
6694 case Instruction::Mul:
6695 case Instruction::And:
6696 case Instruction::Or:
6697 case Instruction::Xor:
6698 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
6699 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
6700 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00006701 case Instruction::LShr:
6702 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006703 return 1;
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006704 default:
6705 return 0; // Cannot fold
6706 }
6707}
6708
6709/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
6710/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
6711static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
6712 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
6713 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
6714 case Instruction::Add:
6715 case Instruction::Sub:
6716 case Instruction::Or:
6717 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006718 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencerfdff9382006-11-08 06:47:33 +00006719 case Instruction::LShr:
6720 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006721 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00006722 case Instruction::And:
6723 return ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
6724 case Instruction::Mul:
6725 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
6726 }
6727}
6728
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006729/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
6730/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
6731Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
6732 Instruction *FI) {
6733 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
6734 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
6735 // merge.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006736 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006737 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
6738 return 0;
6739 } else {
6740 return 0; // unknown unary op.
6741 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006742
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006743 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
6744 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
6745 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
6746 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006747 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
6748 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006749 }
6750
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006751 // Only handle binary operators here.
6752 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006753 return 0;
6754
6755 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
6756 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
6757 bool MatchIsOpZero;
6758 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
6759 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
6760 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
6761 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
6762 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6763 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
6764 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
6765 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
6766 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
6767 MatchIsOpZero = false;
6768 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
6769 return 0;
6770 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
6771 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
6772 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
6773 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
6774 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6775 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
6776 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
6777 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
6778 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
6779 MatchIsOpZero = true;
6780 } else {
6781 return 0;
6782 }
6783
6784 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
6785 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
6786 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
6787 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
6788
6789 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
6790 if (MatchIsOpZero)
6791 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
6792 else
6793 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006794 }
Reid Spencer2f34b982007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006795 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
6796 return 0;
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006797}
6798
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00006799Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006800 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
6801 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
6802 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
6803
6804 // select true, X, Y -> X
6805 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006806 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006808
6809 // select C, X, X -> X
6810 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
6811 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6812
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006813 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
6814 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6815 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
6816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6817 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
6818 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
6819 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6820 else
6821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6822 }
6823
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006824 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00006825 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006826 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006827 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006828 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006829 } else {
6830 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
6831 Value *NotCond =
6832 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
6833 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006834 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006835 }
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00006836 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencercddc9df2007-01-12 04:24:46 +00006837 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006838 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006839 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006840 } else {
6841 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
6842 Value *NotCond =
6843 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
6844 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00006845 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006846 }
6847 }
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006848 }
Chris Lattner1c631e82004-04-08 04:43:23 +00006849
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006850 // Selecting between two integer constants?
6851 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
6852 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
6853 // select C, 1, 0 -> cast C to int
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006854 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006855 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006856 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner183b3362004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006857 // select C, 0, 1 -> cast !C to int
6858 Value *NotCond =
6859 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00006860 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006861 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnercf7baf32004-04-09 18:19:44 +00006862 }
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006863
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006864 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006865
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006866 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
6867 // (x >u 2147483647) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006868 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006869 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
6870 bool CanXForm = false;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006871 if (IC->isSignedPredicate())
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006872 CanXForm = CmpCst->isZero() &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006873 IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006874 else {
6875 unsigned Bits = CmpCst->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006876 CanXForm = CmpCst->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Bits) &&
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006877 IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006878 }
6879
6880 if (CanXForm) {
6881 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006882 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006883 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006884 unsigned Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006885 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
6886 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
6887 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006888 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
6889
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006890 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
6891 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
6892 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
6893 unsigned SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6894 unsigned SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6895 if (SRASize < SISize)
6896 opc = Instruction::SExt;
6897 else if (SRASize > SISize)
6898 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
6899 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006900 }
6901 }
6902
6903
6904 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006905 // have a fcmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006906 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
6907 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006908 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb3f24c92006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006909 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006910 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
6911 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
6912 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006913 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
6914 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
6915 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006916 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
6917 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006918 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
6919 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer959a21d2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00006920 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006921 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner35167c32004-06-09 07:59:58 +00006922 Value *V = ICA;
6923 if (ShouldNotVal)
6924 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
6925 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
6926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
6927 }
Chris Lattner380c7e92006-09-20 04:44:59 +00006928 }
Chris Lattner533bc492004-03-30 19:37:13 +00006929 }
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006930
6931 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006932 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
6933 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006934 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006935 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006936 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6937 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006938 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6940 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6941
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006942 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006943 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006944 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00006945 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006946 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006947 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
6948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6949 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6950 }
6951 }
6952
6953 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
6954 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
6955 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
6956 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
6957 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6958 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6959 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
6960 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6961 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
6962 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6963
6964 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
6965 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
6966 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6967 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
6968 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
6969 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattner24cf0202004-04-11 01:39:19 +00006970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner623fba12004-04-10 22:21:27 +00006971 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
6972 }
6973 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006974
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006975 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
6976 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
6977 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006978 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
6979
Chris Lattner411336f2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00006980 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
6981 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
6982 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
6983 return IV;
6984
6985 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
6986 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00006987 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
6988 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6989 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
6990 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
6991 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6992 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
6993 }
6994
6995 if (AddOp) {
6996 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
6997 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
6998 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
6999 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
7000 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
7001 }
7002
7003 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattnerb580d262006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007004 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
7005 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
7006 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
7007 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
7008 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
7009 } else {
7010 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
7011 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007012 }
Chris Lattnerb580d262006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007013
7014 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
7015 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
7016 if (AddOp != TI)
7017 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
7018 Instruction *NewSel =
7019 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
7020
7021 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
7022 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattnera04c9042005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007023 }
7024 }
7025 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007026
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007027 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007028 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007029 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7030 // transformation we are doing here.
7031 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7032 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7033 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7034 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7035 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7036 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7037 OpToFold = 1;
7038 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7039 OpToFold = 2;
7040 }
7041
7042 if (OpToFold) {
7043 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007044 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007045 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007046 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007047 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007048 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7049 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007050 else {
7051 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7052 }
7053 }
7054 }
Chris Lattner6862fbd2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007055
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007056 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7057 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7058 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7059 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7060 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7061 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7062 OpToFold = 1;
7063 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7064 OpToFold = 2;
7065 }
7066
7067 if (OpToFold) {
7068 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007069 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007070 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007071 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007072 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007073 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7074 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007075 else
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007076 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattner56e4d3d2004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007077 }
7078 }
7079 }
Chris Lattnerd6f636a2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007080
7081 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7082 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7083 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7084 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7085 return &SI;
7086 }
7087
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007088 return 0;
7089}
7090
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007091/// GetKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that we can
7092/// determine, return it, otherwise return 0.
7093static unsigned GetKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD) {
7094 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7095 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
7096 if (Align == 0 && TD)
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007097 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007098 return Align;
7099 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7100 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7101 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7102 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007103 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007104 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7105 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007106 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007107 Align =
7108 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007109 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007110 Align =
7111 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007112 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007113 }
7114 }
7115 return Align;
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007116 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007117 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007118 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007119 User *CI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007120 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
7121 return GetKnownAlignment(CI->getOperand(0), TD);
7122 return 0;
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007123 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V) ||
7124 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
7125 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode()==Instruction::GetElementPtr)) {
7126 User *GEPI = cast<User>(V);
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007127 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD);
7128 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7129
7130 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7131 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7132 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7133 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7134 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7135 AllZeroOperands = false;
7136 break;
7137 }
7138 if (AllZeroOperands)
7139 return BaseAlignment;
7140
7141 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7142 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7143 // least as much as its type requires.
7144 if (!TD) return 0;
7145
7146 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007147 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007148 if (TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType())
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007149 <= BaseAlignment) {
7150 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner50ee0e42007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007151 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007152 return TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner53ef5a02006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007153 }
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007154 return 0;
7155 }
7156 return 0;
7157}
7158
Chris Lattnerb909e8b2004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007159
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007160/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7161/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7162/// the heavy lifting.
7163///
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007164Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007165 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7166 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7167
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007168 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7169 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007170 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007171 bool Changed = false;
7172
7173 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7174 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7175 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7176
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007177 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007178 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007179 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7180 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7181 // alignment is sufficient.
7182 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007183 }
7184
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007185 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7186 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7187 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007188 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007189 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7190 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7191 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner681ef2f2006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007192 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth0ebb0b02006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007193 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007194 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner681ef2f2006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007195 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7196 else
7197 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattnerfbc524f2007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007198 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007199 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7200 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7201 Changed = true;
7202 }
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007203 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007204
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007205 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7206 // set, update the alignment.
7207 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
7208 unsigned Alignment1 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7209 unsigned Alignment2 = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
7210 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007211 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007212 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007213 Changed = true;
7214 }
7215 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
7216 unsigned Alignment = GetKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007217 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007218 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner82f2ef22006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007219 Changed = true;
7220 }
7221 }
7222
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007223 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner503221f2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007224 } else {
7225 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7226 default: break;
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007227 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7228 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007229 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7230 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7231 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7232 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7233 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007234 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007235 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007236 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007237 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7238 }
7239 break;
7240 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7241 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7242 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7243 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007244 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007245 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7246 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerf42d0ae2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007247 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7248 }
7249 break;
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007250 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7251 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7252 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7253 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7254 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
7255 if (GetKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD) >= 16) {
7256 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007257 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7258 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner36dd7c92006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007259 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7260 }
7261 break;
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007262
7263 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7264 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7265 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7266 uint64_t UndefElts;
7267 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7268 UndefElts)) {
7269 II->setOperand(1, V);
7270 return II;
7271 }
7272 break;
7273 }
7274
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007275 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7276 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007277 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007278 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7279
7280 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7281 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7282 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7283 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7284 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7285 AllEltsOk = false;
7286 break;
7287 }
7288 }
7289
7290 if (AllEltsOk) {
7291 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007292 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7293 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7294 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7295 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007296 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7297
7298 // Only extract each element once.
7299 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7300 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7301
7302 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7303 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7304 continue;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007305 unsigned Idx =cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007306 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7307
7308 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7309 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007310 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007311 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7312 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7313 }
7314
7315 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007316 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007317 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7318 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007319 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere79d2492006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007320 }
7321 }
7322 break;
7323
Chris Lattner503221f2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007324 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7325 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7326 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7327 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7328 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7329 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7330 if (&*++BI == II)
7331 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7332 }
7333 }
7334
7335 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7336 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7337 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7338 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7339 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7340 bool CannotRemove = false;
7341 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7342 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7343 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7344 CannotRemove = true;
7345 break;
7346 }
7347 }
7348 if (!CannotRemove)
7349 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7350 }
7351 break;
7352 }
7353 }
Chris Lattner00648e12004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007354 }
7355
Chris Lattnerc66b2232006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007356 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007357}
7358
7359// InvokeInst simplification
7360//
7361Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007362 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007363}
7364
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007365// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7366//
7367Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007368 bool Changed = false;
7369
7370 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7371 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007372 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7373
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007374 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007375
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007376 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7377 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7378 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7379 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7380 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007381 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007382 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner61d9d812005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007383 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7384 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7385 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7386 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7387 return 0;
7388 }
7389
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007390 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7391 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7392 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7393 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007394 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007395 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007396 CS.getInstruction());
7397
7398 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7399 CS.getInstruction()->
7400 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7401
7402 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7403 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7404 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007405 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007406 }
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007407 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7408 }
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007409
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007410 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7411 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7412 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7413 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7414 // the call.
7415 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7416 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7417 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7418 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7419 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7420 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007421 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007422 *I = Op;
7423 Changed = true;
7424 }
7425 }
7426 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007427
Chris Lattner75b4d1d2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007428 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattneraec3d942003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007429}
7430
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007431// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7432// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7433//
7434bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7435 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7436 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007437 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7438 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007439 return false;
Reid Spencer87436872004-07-18 00:38:32 +00007440 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007441 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7442
7443 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
7444 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
7445 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
7446 //
7447 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
7448 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
7449
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007450 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
7451 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007452 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner7051d752007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007453 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
7454 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
7455 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattner400f9592007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007456 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007457
7458 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
7459 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
7460 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
7461 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
7462 if (!Caller->use_empty())
7463 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
7464 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
7465 UI != E; ++UI)
7466 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
7467 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007468 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattner1f7942f2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00007469 return false;
7470 }
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007471
7472 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
7473 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007474
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007475 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
7476 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
7477 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthebfa24e2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007478 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007479 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Andrew Lenharthebfa24e2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00007480 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattner400f9592007-01-06 02:09:32 +00007481 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner7051d752007-01-06 19:53:32 +00007482 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner03c49532007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007483 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007484 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
7485 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng222d5eb2007-03-25 05:01:29 +00007486 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007487 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007488 }
7489
7490 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00007491 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007492 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
7493
7494 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
7495 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
7496 std::vector<Value*> Args;
7497 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
7498
7499 AI = CS.arg_begin();
7500 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7501 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
7502 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
7503 Args.push_back(*AI);
7504 } else {
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007505 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007506 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007507 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007508 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007509 }
7510 }
7511
7512 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
7513 // now...
7514 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
7515 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
7516
7517 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
7518 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
7519 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlingf3baad32006-12-07 01:30:32 +00007520 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
7521 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007522 } else {
7523 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
7524 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
7525 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
7526 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
7527 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007528 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
7529 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007530 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007531 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
7532 Args.push_back(Cast);
7533 } else {
7534 Args.push_back(*AI);
7535 }
7536 }
7537 }
7538
7539 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007540 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007541
7542 Instruction *NC;
7543 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattnerfae8ab32004-02-08 21:44:31 +00007544 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Chris Lattnera06a8fd2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00007545 &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007546 cast<InvokeInst>(II)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007547 } else {
Chris Lattnera06a8fd2007-02-13 02:10:56 +00007548 NC = new CallInst(Callee, &Args[0], Args.size(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattner6aacb0f2005-05-06 06:48:21 +00007549 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
7550 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattner05c703e2005-05-14 12:25:32 +00007551 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007552 }
7553
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007554 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007555 Value *NV = NC;
7556 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
7557 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007558 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007559 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
7560 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer668d90f2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00007561 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner686767f2003-10-30 00:46:41 +00007562
7563 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
7564 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
7565 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
7566 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
7567 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
7568 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
7569 } else {
7570 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
7571 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
7572 }
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007573 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007574 } else {
Chris Lattnere29d6342004-10-17 21:22:38 +00007575 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007576 }
7577 }
7578
7579 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
7580 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattner51f54572007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007581 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00007582 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007583 return true;
7584}
7585
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007586/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
7587/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
7588/// and a single binop.
7589Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
7590 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007591 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
7592 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007593 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007594 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
7595 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
7596
7597 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
7598 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007599
7600 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
7601 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnerdc826fc2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00007602 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007603 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnerdc826fc2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00007604 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007605 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007606 // types or GEP's with different index types.
7607 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
7608 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007609 return 0;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007610
7611 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
7612 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
7613 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
7614 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
7615 return 0;
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007616
7617 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
7618 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
7619 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007620 }
7621
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007622 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
7623
7624 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
7625 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
7626 // hide them behind a phi.
7627 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
7628 return 0;
7629
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007630 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007631 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007632 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007633 if (LHSVal == 0) {
7634 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
7635 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
7636 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007637 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
7638 LHSVal = NewLHS;
7639 }
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007640
7641 if (RHSVal == 0) {
7642 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
7643 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
7644 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007645 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
7646 RHSVal = NewRHS;
7647 }
7648
Chris Lattnercd62f112006-11-08 19:29:23 +00007649 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
7650 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7651 if (NewLHS) {
7652 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
7653 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7654 }
7655 if (NewRHS) {
7656 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
7657 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7658 }
7659 }
7660
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007661 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007662 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007663 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
7664 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
7665 RHSVal);
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007666 else {
7667 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
7668 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
7669 }
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007670}
7671
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007672/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
7673/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
7674/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
7675/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerc9042052007-02-01 22:30:07 +00007676///
7677/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
7678/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
7679/// to a register.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007680static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
7681 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
7682
7683 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
7684 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
7685 return false;
Chris Lattnerc9042052007-02-01 22:30:07 +00007686
7687 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
7688 // profitable to do this xform.
7689 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
7690 bool isAddressTaken = false;
7691 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
7692 UI != E; ++UI) {
7693 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
7694 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
7695 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
7696 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
7697 }
7698 isAddressTaken = true;
7699 break;
7700 }
7701
7702 if (!isAddressTaken)
7703 return false;
7704 }
7705
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007706 return true;
7707}
7708
Chris Lattner970c33a2003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007709
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007710// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
7711// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
7712// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
7713Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
7714 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
7715
7716 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
7717 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
7718 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
7719 // code size and simplifying code.
7720 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
7721 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007722 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007723 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
7724 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007725 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007726 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
7727 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007728 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnercadac0c2006-11-01 04:51:18 +00007729 if (ConstantOp == 0)
7730 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007731 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
7732 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
7733 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
7734 // load and the PHI.
7735 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
7736 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
7737 return 0;
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007738 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner4f218d52006-11-08 19:42:28 +00007739 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattnereebea432006-11-01 07:43:41 +00007740 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
7741 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
7742 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007743 } else {
7744 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
7745 }
7746
7747 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
7748 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7749 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
7750 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007751 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007752 return 0;
7753 if (CastSrcTy) {
7754 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
7755 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007756 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007757 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
7758 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007759 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
7760 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
7761 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
7762 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007763 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
7764 return 0;
7765 }
7766 }
7767
7768 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
7769 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
7770 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
7771 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattnerd8e20182005-01-29 00:39:08 +00007772 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007773
7774 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
7775 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007776
7777 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007778 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7779 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
7780 if (NewInVal != InVal)
7781 InVal = 0;
7782 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
7783 }
7784
7785 Value *PhiVal;
7786 if (InVal) {
7787 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
7788 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
7789 PhiVal = InVal;
7790 delete NewPN;
7791 } else {
7792 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
7793 PhiVal = NewPN;
7794 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007795
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007796 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007797 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
7798 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00007799 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner14f82c72006-11-01 07:13:54 +00007800 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007801 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner46dd5a62004-11-14 19:29:34 +00007802 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007803 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
7804 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
7805 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007806 else
Reid Spencer2341c222007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007807 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenb622c112007-03-05 00:00:42 +00007808 return 0;
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00007809}
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007810
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007811/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
7812/// that is dead.
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007813static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
7814 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007815 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
7816 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
7817
7818 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007819 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007820 return true;
7821
7822 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
7823 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007824
Chris Lattner71536432005-01-17 05:10:15 +00007825 return false;
7826}
7827
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00007828// PHINode simplification
7829//
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007830Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonbbf89902006-07-10 22:15:25 +00007831 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +00007832 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersona6968f82006-07-10 19:03:49 +00007833
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007834 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
7835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
7836
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007837 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
7838 // reducing code size.
7839 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
7840 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
7841 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
7842 return Result;
7843
7844 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
7845 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
7846 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerc8dcede2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00007847 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
7848 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
7849 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattnerd2602d52007-03-26 20:40:50 +00007850 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007851 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
7852 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
7853 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
7854 }
Chris Lattnerc8dcede2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00007855
7856 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
7857 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
7858 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
7859 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
7860 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
7861 // late.
7862 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
7863 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
7864 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
7865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
7866 }
7867 }
Owen Andersonae8aa642006-07-10 22:03:18 +00007868
Chris Lattner91daeb52003-12-19 05:58:40 +00007869 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbbbdd852002-05-06 18:06:38 +00007870}
7871
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007872static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
7873 Instruction *InsertPoint,
7874 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer8f166b02007-01-08 16:32:00 +00007875 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7876 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007877 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
7878 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
7879 // used for address computation.
7880 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
7881 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
7882 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
7883 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007884}
7885
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007886
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007887Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007888 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner471bd762003-05-22 19:07:21 +00007889 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, long 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007890 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007891 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007892 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007893
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007894 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
7895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
7896
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00007897 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
7898 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
7899 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
7900
7901 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007902 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattner48a44f72002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007903
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007904 // Keep track of whether all indices are zero constants integers.
7905 bool AllZeroIndices = true;
7906
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007907 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
7908 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007909
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007910 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007911 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
7912 // Track whether this GEP has all zero indices, if so, it doesn't move the
7913 // input pointer, it just changes its type.
7914 if (AllZeroIndices) {
7915 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(i)))
7916 AllZeroIndices = CI->isNullValue();
7917 else
7918 AllZeroIndices = false;
7919 }
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007920 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
7921 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner27df1db2007-01-15 07:02:54 +00007922 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
7923 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
7924 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
7925 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
7926 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
7927 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
7928 MadeChange = true;
7929 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007930 }
7931 }
7932 }
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007933 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
7934 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
7935 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
7936 // obvious.
7937 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007938 if (TD->getTypeSize(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00007939 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007940 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner1e9ac1a2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00007941 MadeChange = true;
7942 } else {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007943 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
7944 GEP);
Chris Lattner2b2412d2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00007945 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
7946 MadeChange = true;
7947 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007948 }
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007949 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007950 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
7951
Chris Lattner9bf53ff2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00007952 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
7953 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
7954 // real input to the dest type.
7955 if (AllZeroIndices && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
7956 return new BitCastInst(cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))->getOperand(0),
7957 GEP.getType());
7958
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007959 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
7960 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
7961 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
7962 //
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00007963 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner0798af32005-01-13 20:14:25 +00007964 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00007965 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00007966
7967 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007968 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
7969 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
7970 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
7971 //
7972 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
7973 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
7974 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
7975
Chris Lattneraf6094f2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00007976 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007977
7978 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
7979 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
7980 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
7981 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattner8ec5f882004-05-08 22:41:42 +00007982 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007983
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00007984 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007985 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattner235af562003-03-05 22:33:14 +00007986 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
7987 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
7988 //
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00007989 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00007990 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
7991 Sum = GO1;
7992 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
7993 Sum = SO1;
7994 } else {
7995 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
7996 // target's pointer size.
7997 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
7998 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007999 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008000 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008001 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008002 } else {
8003 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008004 if (TD->getTypeSize(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008005 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008006 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008007
Reid Spencer7a9c62b2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008008 } else if (TD->getTypeSize(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008009 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008010 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008011 } else {
8012 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008013 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
8014 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008015 }
8016 }
8017 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008018 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
8019 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
8020 else {
Chris Lattnerdf20a4d2004-06-10 02:07:29 +00008021 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
8022 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008023 }
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008024 }
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008025
8026 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
8027 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8028 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8029 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8030 return &GEP;
8031 } else {
8032 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8033 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8034 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8035 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8036 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008037 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner69193f92004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008038 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008039 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008040 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattner57c67b02004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008041 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8042 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008043 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8044 }
8045
8046 if (!Indices.empty())
Chris Lattnera7315132007-02-12 22:56:41 +00008047 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], &Indices[0],
8048 Indices.size(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008049
Chris Lattner5f667a62004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008050 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008051 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8052 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8053
8054 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008055 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008056 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8057 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8058 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8059
8060 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008061 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8062 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattnerc59af1d2002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008063
8064 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8065 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8066 }
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008067 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008068 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8069 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8070 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
8071 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
8072 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
8073 //
8074 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8075 //
8076 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8077 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8078 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8079 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8080 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8081 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8082 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8083 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8084 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8085 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8086 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8087 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8088 return &GEP;
8089 }
8090 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8091 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008092 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
8093 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008094 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
8095 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
8096 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
8097 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
8098 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
8099 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008100 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner567b81f2005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008101 GEP.getOperand(1), GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008102 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
8103 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008104 }
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008105
8106 // Transform things like:
8107 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
8108 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
8109 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
8110
8111 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008112 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008113 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
8114 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
8115
8116 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
8117 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
8118 Value *NewIdx = 0;
8119 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
8120 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
8121 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
8122 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
8123 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnera393e4d2005-09-14 17:32:56 +00008124 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008125 Scale = CI;
8126 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
8127 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
8128 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008129 unsigned ShAmt =
8130 cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008131 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmt);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008132 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8133 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
8134 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
8135 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8136 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8137 }
8138 }
8139
8140 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
8141 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008142 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008143 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008144 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
8145 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
8146 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008147 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
8148 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008149 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
8150 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
8151 }
8152
8153 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008154 Instruction *NewGEP =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008155 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty),
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008156 NewIdx, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008157 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
8158 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
8159 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner2a893292005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008160 }
8161 }
Chris Lattner8d0bacb2004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008162 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008163 }
8164
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008165 return 0;
8166}
8167
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008168Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
8169 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
8170 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008171 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8172 const Type *NewTy =
8173 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008174 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008175
8176 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
8177 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008178 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008179 else {
8180 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman848622f2005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008181 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattnera2620ac2002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008182 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008183
8184 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008185
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008186 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
8187 // allocas if possible...
8188 //
8189 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
8190 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
8191
8192 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
8193 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
8194 //
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008195 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattner809dfac2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00008196 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, NullIdx, NullIdx,
8197 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008198
8199 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
8200 // allocation.
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008201 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008202 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8203 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008204 }
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008205
8206 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
8207 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
8208 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008209 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattner49df6ce2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00008210 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattnerabb77c92004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008211 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
8212
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008213 return 0;
8214}
8215
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008216Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
8217 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
8218
8219 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
8220 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op))
8221 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
8222 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
8223 return &FI;
8224 }
8225
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008226 // free undef -> unreachable.
8227 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
8228 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng75b871f2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008229 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer542964f2007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008230 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008231 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8232 }
8233
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008234 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
8235 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008236 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008237 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattnerf3a36602004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008238
Chris Lattner8427bff2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008239 return 0;
8240}
8241
8242
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008243/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008244static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
8245 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008246 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008247
8248 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008249 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008250 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008251
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008252 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008253 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008254 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8255 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8256 // constants.
8257 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8258 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8259 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008260 Value *Idxs[2];
8261 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8262 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008263 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8264 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8265 }
8266
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008267 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008268 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerecfa9b52005-03-29 06:37:47 +00008269 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
8270 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
8271 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008272 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8273 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008274
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008275 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
8276 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
8277 // the result of the loaded value.
8278 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
8279 CI->getName(),
8280 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
8281 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008282 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerfe1b0b82005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008283 }
Chris Lattner35e24772004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008284 }
8285 }
8286 return 0;
8287}
8288
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008289/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008290/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
8291/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
8292/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
8293static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
8294 // If it is an alloca or global variable, it is always safe to load from.
8295 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V) || isa<GlobalVariable>(V)) return true;
8296
8297 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
8298 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008299 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
8300 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
8301 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008302 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
8303
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008304 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008305 --BBI;
8306
8307 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8308 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
8309 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8310 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008311
Alkis Evlogimenosd59cebf2004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008312 }
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008313 return false;
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008314}
8315
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008316Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
8317 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7e8af382004-01-12 04:13:56 +00008318
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008319 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008320 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008321 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8322 return Res;
8323
8324 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
8325 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008326
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008327 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
8328 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattnere0bfdf12005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008329 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
8330 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008331 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8332 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
8333 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnere0bfdf12005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008334 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
8335 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
8336 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattnerb990f7d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008337 }
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008338
8339 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
8340 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0)) ||
8341 isa<UndefValue>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
8342 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8343 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8344 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8345 // CFG.
8346 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8347 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8349 }
8350
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008351 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008352 // load null/undef -> undef
8353 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008354 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
8355 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
8356 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008357 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8358 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8ba9ec92004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008360 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008361
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008362 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
8363 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008364 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008366
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008367 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
8368 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
8369 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
8370 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5301e7c2007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008371 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner0b011ec2005-09-26 05:28:06 +00008372 if (Constant *V =
8373 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008374 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008375 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
8376 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8377 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8378 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8379 // CFG.
8380 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8381 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8383 }
8384
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008385 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008386 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8387 return Res;
8388 }
8389 }
Chris Lattnere228ee52004-04-08 20:39:49 +00008390
Chris Lattnera9d84e32005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008391 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008392 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
8393 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
8394 // exposes redundancy in the code.
8395 //
8396 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
8397 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
8398 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
8399 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
8400 // unconditionally.
8401 //
8402 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
8403 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattnere6f13092004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008404 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
8405 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008406 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008407 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008408 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner42618552004-09-20 10:15:10 +00008409 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008410 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
8411 }
8412
Chris Lattnerbdcf41a2004-09-23 15:46:00 +00008413 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
8414 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
8415 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8416 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
8417 return &LI;
8418 }
8419
8420 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
8421 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
8422 if (C->isNullValue()) {
8423 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
8424 return &LI;
8425 }
Chris Lattnerf62ea8e2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008426 }
8427 }
Chris Lattner0f1d8a32003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008428 return 0;
8429}
8430
Reid Spencere928a152007-01-19 21:20:31 +00008431/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008432/// when possible.
8433static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
8434 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
8435 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
8436
8437 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8438 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
8439 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8440
Reid Spencer31a4ef42007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008441 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008442 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8443 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8444 // constants.
8445 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8446 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8447 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattnerf96f4a82007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008448 Value* Idxs[2];
8449 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8450 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008451 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8452 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8453 }
8454
Reid Spencer9a4bed02007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008455 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
8456 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8457 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008458
8459 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008460 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
8461 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008462 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008463 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008464 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
8465 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
8466 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
8467 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
8468 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008469 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer9a4bed02007-01-20 23:35:48 +00008470 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencer74a528b2006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008471 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerbb65ebf2006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008472 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
8473 }
8474 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008475 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008476 else
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008477 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencerc050af92007-01-18 18:54:33 +00008478 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
8479 SI);
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008480 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
8481 }
8482 }
8483 }
8484 return 0;
8485}
8486
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008487Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
8488 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
8489 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
8490
8491 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008492 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008493 ++NumCombined;
8494 return 0;
8495 }
Chris Lattnera4beeef2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00008496
8497 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
8498 // alloca dead.
8499 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
8500 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
8501 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8502 ++NumCombined;
8503 return 0;
8504 }
8505
8506 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
8507 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
8508 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8509 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8510 ++NumCombined;
8511 return 0;
8512 }
8513 }
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008514
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008515 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
8516 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
8517 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
8518 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
8519 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
8520 --ScanInsts) {
8521 --BBI;
8522
8523 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
8524 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
8525 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8526 ++NumDeadStore;
8527 ++BBI;
8528 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
8529 continue;
8530 }
8531 break;
8532 }
8533
Chris Lattnerdab43b22006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008534 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
8535 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
8536 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
8537 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8538 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr) {
8539 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8540 ++NumCombined;
8541 return 0;
8542 }
8543 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
8544 // may not be dead.
8545 break;
8546 }
8547
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008548 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerdab43b22006-05-26 19:19:20 +00008549 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008550 break;
8551 }
8552
8553
8554 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008555
8556 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
8557 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
8558 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
8559 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
8560 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008561 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008562 ++NumCombined;
8563 }
8564 return 0; // Do not modify these!
8565 }
8566
8567 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
8568 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008569 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008570 ++NumCombined;
8571 return 0;
8572 }
8573
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008574 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
8575 // source instead.
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008576 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008577 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
8578 return Res;
8579 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer6c38f0b2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008580 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattner72684fe2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008581 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
8582 return Res;
8583
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008584
8585 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
8586 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008587 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008588 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
8589 if (BI->isUnconditional()) {
8590 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
8591 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
8592 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
8593 BasicBlock *Dest = BI->getSuccessor(0);
8594
8595 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(Dest);
8596 BasicBlock *Other = 0;
8597 if (*PI != BI->getParent())
8598 Other = *PI;
8599 ++PI;
8600 if (PI != pred_end(Dest)) {
8601 if (*PI != BI->getParent())
8602 if (Other)
8603 Other = 0;
8604 else
8605 Other = *PI;
8606 if (++PI != pred_end(Dest))
8607 Other = 0;
8608 }
8609 if (Other) { // If only one other pred...
8610 BBI = Other->getTerminator();
8611 // Make sure this other block ends in an unconditional branch and that
8612 // there is an instruction before the branch.
8613 if (isa<BranchInst>(BBI) && cast<BranchInst>(BBI)->isUnconditional() &&
8614 BBI != Other->begin()) {
8615 --BBI;
8616 StoreInst *OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
8617
8618 // If this instruction is a store to the same location.
8619 if (OtherStore && OtherStore->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
8620 // Okay, we know we can perform this transformation. Insert a PHI
8621 // node now if we need it.
8622 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
8623 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
8624 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
8625 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
8626 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
8627 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), Other);
8628 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, Dest->front());
8629 }
8630
8631 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
8632 // insert it.
8633 BBI = Dest->begin();
8634 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
8635 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
8636 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
8637
8638 // Nuke the old stores.
Chris Lattner5997cf92006-02-08 03:25:32 +00008639 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
8640 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
Chris Lattner219175c2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00008641 ++NumCombined;
8642 return 0;
8643 }
8644 }
8645 }
8646 }
8647
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00008648 return 0;
8649}
8650
8651
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00008652Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
8653 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4fdd96c2005-06-18 17:37:34 +00008654 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008655 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
8656 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
8657 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
8658 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
8659 // Swap Destinations and condition...
8660 BI.setCondition(X);
8661 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8662 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
8663 return &BI;
8664 }
8665
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008666 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
8667 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
8668 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
8669 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
8670 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
8671 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
8672 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008673 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008674 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
8675 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008676 // Swap Destinations and condition...
8677 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
8678 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8679 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008680 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008681 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008682 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008683 return &BI;
8684 }
8685
8686 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
8687 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
8688 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
8689 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
8690 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
8691 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
8692 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
8693 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008694 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008695 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
8696 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008697 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattnerd4252a72004-07-30 07:50:03 +00008698 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008699 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
8700 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008701 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008702 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008703 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattnere967b342003-06-04 05:10:11 +00008704 return &BI;
8705 }
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008706
Chris Lattner9eef8a72003-06-04 04:46:00 +00008707 return 0;
8708}
Chris Lattner1085bdf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008709
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008710Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
8711 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
8712 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
8713 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
8714 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
8715 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
8716 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattner81a7a232004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008717 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008718 AddRHS));
8719 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008720 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4c9c20a2004-07-03 00:26:11 +00008721 return &SI;
8722 }
8723 }
8724 return 0;
8725}
8726
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008727/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
8728/// is to leave as a vector operation.
8729static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
8730 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
8731 return true;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008732 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008733 if (isConstant) return true;
8734 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
8735 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
8736 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
8737 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
8738 return false;
8739 return true;
8740 }
8741 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
8742 if (!I) return false;
8743
8744 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
8745 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
8746 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
8747 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
8748 return true;
8749 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
8750 return true;
8751 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
8752 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
8753 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
8754 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
8755 return true;
Reid Spencer266e42b2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008756 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
8757 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
8758 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
8759 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
8760 return true;
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008761
8762 return false;
8763}
8764
Chris Lattner945e4372007-02-14 05:52:17 +00008765/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
8766///
8767/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
8768/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008769static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
8770 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
8771 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
8772 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
8773 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
8774 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
8775
8776 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008777 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008778 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
8779 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
8780 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
8781 else
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008782 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008783 return Result;
8784}
8785
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008786/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
8787/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
8788/// extracted from the vector.
8789static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008790 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
8791 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008792 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
8793 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008794 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
8795
8796 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
8797 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
8798 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
8799 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008800 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008801 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
8802 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8803 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008804 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
8805 return 0;
8806 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008807
8808 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
8809 // inserted value.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008810 if (EltNo == IIElt)
8811 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008812
8813 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
8814 // vector input.
8815 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008816 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008817 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
8818 if (InEl < Width)
8819 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
8820 else if (InEl < Width*2)
8821 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
8822 else
8823 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008824 }
8825
8826 // Otherwise, we don't know.
8827 return 0;
8828}
8829
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008830Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008831
Chris Lattner92346c32006-03-31 18:25:14 +00008832 // If packed val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
8833 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
8834 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
8835
8836 // If packed val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
8837 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
8838 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
8839
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008840 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008841 // If packed val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
8842 // with that operand
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008843 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008844 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008845 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
8846 op0 = 0;
8847 break;
8848 }
8849 if (op0)
8850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008851 }
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008852
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008853 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
8854 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008855 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008856 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
8857 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
8858 // property.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008859 uint64_t IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008860 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
8861 uint64_t UndefElts;
8862 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008863 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008864 UndefElts)) {
8865 EI.setOperand(0, V);
8866 return &EI;
8867 }
8868 }
8869
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008870 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008871 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattner2d37f922006-04-10 23:06:36 +00008872 }
Chris Lattner8d1d8d32006-03-31 23:01:56 +00008873
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008874 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008875 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
8876 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
8877 // profitable to do so
8878 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner6bc98652006-03-05 00:22:33 +00008879 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
8880 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
8881 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
8882 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
8883 EI.getName()+".lhs");
8884 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
8885 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
8886 EI.getName()+".rhs");
8887 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
8888 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
8889 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
8890 }
Reid Spencerde46e482006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008891 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer13bc5d72006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008892 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008893 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
8894 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencera736fdf2006-11-29 01:11:01 +00008895 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008896 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
8897 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008898 }
8899 }
8900 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
8901 // Extracting the inserted element?
8902 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
8903 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
8904 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
8905 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
8906 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
8907 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
8908 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
8909 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
8910 return &EI;
8911 }
8912 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
8913 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
8914 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008915 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
8916 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00008917 Value *Src;
8918 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
8919 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
8920 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
8921 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
8922 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
8923 } else {
8924 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner612fa8e2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00008925 }
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008926 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008927 }
8928 }
Chris Lattner83f65782006-05-25 22:53:38 +00008929 }
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00008930 return 0;
8931}
8932
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008933/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
8934/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
8935/// Otherwise, return false.
8936static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
8937 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
8938 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
8939 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008940 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008941
8942 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008943 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008944 return true;
8945 } else if (V == LHS) {
8946 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008947 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008948 return true;
8949 } else if (V == RHS) {
8950 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008951 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008952 return true;
8953 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
8954 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
8955 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
8956 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
8957 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
8958
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008959 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
8960 return false;
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008961 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008962
8963 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
8964 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
8965 // transitively ok.
8966 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
8967 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008968 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerb6cb64b2006-04-27 21:14:21 +00008969 return true;
8970 }
8971 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
8972 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008973 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
8974 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008975 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008976
8977 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
8978 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
8979 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
8980 // transitively ok.
8981 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
8982 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
8983 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
8984 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008985 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008986 } else {
8987 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
8988 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008989 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00008990
8991 }
8992 return true;
8993 }
8994 }
8995 }
8996 }
8997 }
8998 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
8999
9000 return false;
9001}
9002
9003/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
9004/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
9005/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009006static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009007 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009008 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009009 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009010 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009011 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009012
9013 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009014 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009015 return V;
9016 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009017 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009018 return V;
9019 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9020 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9021 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9022 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9023 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9024
9025 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9026 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9027 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9028 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009029 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9030 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009031
9032 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
9033 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009034 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
9035 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
9036 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009037 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009038 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009039 return V;
9040 }
9041
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009042 if (VecOp == RHS) {
9043 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009044 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
9045 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
9046 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009047 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009048 }
9049 return V;
9050 }
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009051
9052 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
9053 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
9054 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
9055 return EI->getOperand(0);
9056
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009057 }
9058 }
9059 }
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009060 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009061
9062 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
9063 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009064 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009065 return V;
9066}
9067
9068Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
9069 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
9070 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
9071 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
9072
9073 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
9074 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
9075 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9076 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9077 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
9078 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Reid Spencere0fc4df2006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009079 unsigned ExtractedIdx=cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9080 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009081
9082 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
9083 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9084
9085 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
9086 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
9087
9088 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
9089 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
9090 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
9091 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9092
9093 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
9094 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
9095 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
9096 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
9097 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
9098 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
9099 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
9100 // Build a new shuffle mask.
9101 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
9102 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009103 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009104 else {
9105 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009106 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009107 NumVectorElts));
9108 }
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009109 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009110 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009111 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009112 }
9113
9114 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
9115 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
9116 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
9117 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner90951862006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009118 Value *RHS = 0;
9119 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
9120 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
9121 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009122 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009123 }
9124 }
9125 }
9126
9127 return 0;
9128}
9129
9130
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009131Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
9132 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9133 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009134 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009135
9136 bool MadeChange = false;
9137
Chris Lattner2deeaea2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009138 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009139 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009140 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
9141
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009142 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009143 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009144 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
9145 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
9146 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
9147 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9148 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
9149 Mask[i] = 2*e;
9150 MadeChange = true;
9151 }
9152 }
9153
9154 if (MadeChange) {
9155 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9156 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9157 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9158 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
9159 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
9160 else
9161 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
9162 }
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009163 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnerd7b6ea12007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009164 }
9165 }
Chris Lattner39fac442006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009166
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009167 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
9168 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
9169 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
9170 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009171 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
9172 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9173 }
9174
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009175 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9176 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9177 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009178 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009179 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009180 else {
9181 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
9182 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
9183 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
9184 else
9185 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009186 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009187 }
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009188 }
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009189 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009190 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009191 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009192 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9193 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009194 MadeChange = true;
9195 }
9196
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009197 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009198 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner34cebe72006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009199
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009200 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9201 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
9202 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
9203 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
9204
9205 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
9206 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner34cebe72006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009207 }
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009208
Chris Lattner12249be2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009209 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
9210 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9211 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009212
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009213 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
9214 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
9215 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
9216 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
9217 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
9218 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
9219 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
9220 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
9221 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
9222 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
9223 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
9224 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
9225
9226 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
9227 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
9228 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
9229 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
9230 else
9231 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
9232
9233 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
9234 // the replacement.
9235 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
9236 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9237 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9238 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009239 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009240 } else {
Reid Spencerc635f472006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009241 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009242 }
9243 }
9244 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
9245 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencerd84d35b2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009246 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner0e477162006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009247 }
9248 }
9249 }
Chris Lattner4284f642007-01-30 22:32:46 +00009250
Chris Lattnerfbb77a42006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009251 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
9252}
9253
9254
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009255
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009256
9257/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
9258/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
9259/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
9260/// end of its block.
9261static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
9262 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
9263
Chris Lattnerc4f67e62005-10-27 17:13:11 +00009264 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
9265 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009266
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009267 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmandcb291f2007-03-22 16:38:57 +00009268 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
9269 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009270 return false;
9271
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009272 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
9273 // the end of block that could change the value.
9274 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009275 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
9276 Scan != E; ++Scan)
9277 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
9278 return false;
Chris Lattnerf17a2fb2004-12-09 07:14:34 +00009279 }
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009280
9281 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
9282 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
9283
Chris Lattner9f269e42005-08-08 19:11:57 +00009284 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009285 ++NumSunkInst;
9286 return true;
9287}
9288
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009289
9290/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
9291/// all reachable code to the worklist.
9292///
9293/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
9294/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
9295/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
9296/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
9297/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
9298///
9299static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009300 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009301 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009302 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009303 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
9304 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009305
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009306 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9307 BB = Worklist.back();
9308 Worklist.pop_back();
9309
9310 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
9311 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
9312
9313 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
9314 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009315
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009316 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
9317 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
9318 ++NumDeadInst;
9319 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
9320 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9321 continue;
9322 }
9323
9324 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
9325 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
9326 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
9327 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
9328 ++NumConstProp;
9329 Inst->eraseFromParent();
9330 continue;
9331 }
9332
9333 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009334 }
Chris Lattner12b89cc2007-03-23 19:17:18 +00009335
9336 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
9337 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
9338 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
9339 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
9340 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
9341 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
9342 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
9343 continue;
9344 }
9345 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
9346 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
9347 // See if this is an explicit destination.
9348 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9349 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
9350 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
9351 continue;
9352 }
9353
9354 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
9355 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
9356 continue;
9357 }
9358 }
9359
9360 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
9361 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009362 }
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009363}
9364
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009365bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009366 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerf4ad1652003-11-02 05:57:39 +00009367 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009368
9369 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
9370 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009371
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009372 {
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009373 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
9374 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
9375 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner7907e5f2007-02-15 19:41:52 +00009376 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009377 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen5f4ef3c2005-07-27 06:12:32 +00009378
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009379 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
9380 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
9381 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
9382 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
9383 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
9384 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
9385 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
9386 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner2d3a7a62004-04-27 15:13:33 +00009387
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009388 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattner4ed40f72005-07-07 20:40:38 +00009389 ++NumDeadInst;
9390
9391 if (!I->use_empty())
9392 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
9393 I->eraseFromParent();
9394 }
9395 }
9396 }
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009397
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009398 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
9399 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
9400 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009401
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009402 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009403 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009404 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009405 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009406 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009407 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009408
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009409 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009410
9411 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009412 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009413 continue;
9414 }
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009415
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009416 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattnere3eda252007-01-30 23:16:15 +00009417 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009418 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnercd517ff2005-01-28 19:32:01 +00009419
Chris Lattner1443bc52006-05-11 17:11:52 +00009420 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner51ea1272004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009421 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc6509f42002-12-05 22:41:53 +00009422 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
9423
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009424 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnera36ee4e2006-05-10 19:00:36 +00009425 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009426 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009427 continue;
Chris Lattner99f48c62002-09-02 04:59:56 +00009428 }
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009429
Chris Lattner39c98bb2004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009430 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
9431 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9432 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
9433 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
9434 if (UserParent != BB) {
9435 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
9436 // See if the user is one of our successors.
9437 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
9438 if (*SI == UserParent) {
9439 UserIsSuccessor = true;
9440 break;
9441 }
9442
9443 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
9444 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
9445 // otherwise), we can keep going.
9446 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
9447 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
9448 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
9449 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
9450 }
9451 }
9452
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009453 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +00009454#ifndef NDEBUG
9455 std::string OrigI;
9456#endif
9457 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009458 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner0b18c1d2002-05-10 15:38:35 +00009459 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009460 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009461 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendling5dbf43c2006-11-26 09:46:52 +00009462 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
9463 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009464
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009465 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
9466 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
9467
9468 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009469 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009470 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009471
Chris Lattner6e0123b2007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009472 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
9473 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009474
9475 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
9476 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattner7515cab2004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009477 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
9478
9479 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
9480 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
9481 ++InsertPos;
9482
9483 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009484
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009485 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
9486 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009487 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerb643a9e2004-05-01 23:19:52 +00009488
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009489 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
9490 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009491 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnere8ed4ef2003-10-06 17:11:01 +00009492
9493 // Erase the old instruction.
9494 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner113f4f42002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009495 } else {
Evan Chenga4ed8a52007-03-27 16:44:48 +00009496#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencer755d0e72007-03-26 17:44:01 +00009497 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
9498 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chenga4ed8a52007-03-27 16:44:48 +00009499#endif
Chris Lattner7d2a5392004-03-13 23:54:27 +00009500
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009501 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
9502 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009503 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
9504 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
9505 // use counts.
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009506 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanb1c93172005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009507
Chris Lattner63d75af2004-05-01 23:27:23 +00009508 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchinoa8352962006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009509 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerb15e2b12007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009510 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner31f486c2005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009511 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner396dbfe2004-06-09 05:08:07 +00009512 } else {
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009513 AddToWorkList(I);
9514 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerae7a0d32002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009515 }
Chris Lattner053c0932002-05-14 15:24:07 +00009516 }
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009517 Changed = true;
Chris Lattnerca081252001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009518 }
9519 }
9520
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009521 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009522 return Changed;
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00009523}
9524
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009525
9526bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattner8258b442007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009527 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
9528
Chris Lattner960a5432007-03-03 02:04:50 +00009529 bool EverMadeChange = false;
9530
9531 // Iterate while there is work to do.
9532 unsigned Iteration = 0;
9533 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
9534 EverMadeChange = true;
9535 return EverMadeChange;
9536}
9537
Brian Gaeke38b79e82004-07-27 17:43:21 +00009538FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattner260ab202002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009539 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattner04805fa2002-02-26 21:46:54 +00009540}
Brian Gaeke960707c2003-11-11 22:41:34 +00009541